|
- @chapter Filtering Introduction
- @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
-
- Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
-
- In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
- outputs.
- To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
- following filtergraph.
-
- @verbatim
- [main]
- input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
- | ^
- |[tmp] [flip]|
- +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
- @end verbatim
-
- This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
- stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
- back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
- following command to achieve this:
-
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
- onto the bottom half of the output video.
-
- Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
- linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
- @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
- @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
- chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
- example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
- the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
-
- The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
- @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
- away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
- @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
- split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
- lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
-
- Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
- after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
- by a colon.
-
- There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
- audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
- output.
-
- @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
-
- @chapter graph2dot
- @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
-
- The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
- directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
- corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
-
- Invoke the command:
- @example
- graph2dot -h
- @end example
-
- to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
-
- You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
- the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
- of the filtergraph.
-
- For example the sequence of commands:
- @example
- echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
- tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
- dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
- display graph.png
- @end example
-
- can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
- described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
- a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
- For example if your command line is of the form:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
- @end example
- your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
- @example
- nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
- @end example
- you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
- filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
-
- @c man end GRAPH2DOT
-
- @chapter Filtergraph description
- @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
-
- A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
- cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
- filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
- filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
- side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
-
- Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
- registered in the application, which defines the features and the
- number of input and output pads of the filter.
-
- A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
- output pads is called a "sink".
-
- @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
- @section Filtergraph syntax
-
- A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
- @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
- @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
- @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
- @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
- @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
-
- A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
- connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
- represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
-
- A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
- filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
- descriptions.
-
- A filter is represented by a string of the form:
- [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
-
- @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
- described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
- the filter classes registered in the program.
- The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
- "=@var{arguments}".
-
- @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
- initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
- @itemize
-
- @item
- A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
-
- @item
- A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
- the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
- declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
- @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
- @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
- @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
-
- @item
- A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
- pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
- follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
- @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
-
- @end itemize
-
- If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
- takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
- @samp{|}.
-
- The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
- and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
- within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
- terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
- @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
-
- The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
- followed by a list of link labels.
- A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
- or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
- ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
- the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
- associated to the output pads.
-
- When two link labels with the same name are found in the
- filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
- created.
-
- If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
- unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
- For example in the filterchain
- @example
- nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
- @end example
- the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
- instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
- "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
- output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
- which are both unlabelled.
-
- In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
- specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
- specified, "out" is assumed.
-
- In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
- pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
- filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
-
- Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
- conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
- for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
- @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
- to the filtergraph description.
-
- Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
- @example
- @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
- @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
- @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
- @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
- @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
- @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
- @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
- @end example
-
- @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
-
- Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
- escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
- section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
- information about the employed escaping procedure.
-
- A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
- value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
- separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
-
- A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
- may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
- characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
-
- Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
- need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
- characters contained within it.
-
- For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
- the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
- @example
- this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
- @end example
-
- This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
- @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
- @example
- text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
- @end example
-
- A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
- description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
- filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
- @example
- drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
- @end example
- (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
- also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
-
- Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
- filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
- escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
- @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
- previous string will finally result in:
- @example
- -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
- @end example
-
- @chapter Timeline editing
-
- Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
- supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
- evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
- the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
- next filter in the filtergraph.
-
- The expression accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item t
- timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
-
- @item n
- sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
-
- @item pos
- the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
-
- @item w
- @item h
- width and height of the input frame if video
- @end table
-
- Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
- to re-define the expression.
-
- Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
- rules.
-
- For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
- minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
- @example
- smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
- curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
- @end example
-
- @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
-
- @chapter Audio Filters
- @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
-
- When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
- existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
- The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
- build.
-
- Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
-
- @section acompressor
-
- A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
- Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
- improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
- of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
- If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
- afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
- but can also destroy a track completely).
- The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
- the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
- it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
-
- Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
- @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
- So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
- of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
- the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
- levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
- @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
- before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
- has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
- than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
- The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
- @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
- raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
- source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
- hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
-
- @item threshold
- If a signal of second stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
- reduction of the first stream.
- By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
-
- @item ratio
- Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
- rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
- Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
-
- @item attack
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
- reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
-
- @item release
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
- reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
-
- @item makeup
- Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
- Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
-
- @item knee
- Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
- Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
-
- @item link
- Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
- or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
- reduction. Default is @code{average}.
-
- @item detection
- Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
- of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
-
- @item mix
- How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
- Range is between 0 and 1.
- @end table
-
- @section acrossfade
-
- Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
- The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item nb_samples, ns
- Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
- At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
- silent. Default is 44100.
-
- @item duration, d
- Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
- By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
- If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
-
- @item overlap, o
- Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
-
- @item curve1
- Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
-
- @item curve2
- Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
-
- For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Cross fade from one input to another:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
- @end example
-
- @item
- Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section adelay
-
- Delay one or more audio channels.
-
- Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item delays
- Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
- At least one delay greater than 0 should be provided.
- Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
- smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
- the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
- @example
- adelay=1500|0|500
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section aecho
-
- Apply echoing to the input audio.
-
- Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
- (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
- effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
- sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
- original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
- loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
- Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
-
- A description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item in_gain
- Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
-
- @item out_gain
- Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
-
- @item delays
- Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
- separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
- Default is @code{1000}.
-
- @item decays
- Set list of loudnesses of reflected signals separated by '|'.
- Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
- Default is @code{0.5}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
- @example
- aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
- @end example
-
- @item
- If delay is very short, then it sound like a (metallic) robot playing music:
- @example
- aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
- @end example
-
- @item
- A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
- @example
- aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
- @end example
-
- @item
- Same as above but with one more mountain:
- @example
- aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section aemphasis
- Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
- emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
- signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
- this recording medium.
- Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
- restore the distortion of the frequency response.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input gain.
-
- @item level_out
- Set output gain.
-
- @item mode
- Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
- use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
-
- @item type
- Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @option
- @item col
- select Columbia.
- @item emi
- select EMI.
- @item bsi
- select BSI (78RPM).
- @item riaa
- select RIAA.
- @item cd
- select Compact Disc (CD).
- @item 50fm
- select 50µs (FM).
- @item 75fm
- select 75µs (FM).
- @item 50kf
- select 50µs (FM-KF).
- @item 75kf
- select 75µs (FM-KF).
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section aeval
-
- Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
-
- This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
- which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item exprs
- Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
- the number of input channels is greater than the number of
- expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
- output channels.
-
- @item channel_layout, c
- Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
- specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
- use by default the same input channel layout.
- @end table
-
- Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
-
- @table @option
- @item ch
- channel number of the current expression
-
- @item n
- number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
-
- @item s
- sample rate
-
- @item t
- time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
-
- @item nb_in_channels
- @item nb_out_channels
- input and output number of channels
-
- @item val(CH)
- the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
- @end table
-
- Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
- dedicated filter.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Half volume:
- @example
- aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
- @end example
-
- @item
- Invert phase of the second channel:
- @example
- aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{afade}
- @section afade
-
- Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
-
- A description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item type, t
- Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
- @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
-
- @item start_sample, ss
- Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
- effect. Default is 0.
-
- @item nb_samples, ns
- Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
- the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
- volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
- the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
-
- @item start_time, st
- Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
- The value must be specified as a time duration; see
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
- If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
-
- @item duration, d
- Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
- At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
- volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
- the output audio will be silence.
- By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
- If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
-
- @item curve
- Set curve for fade transition.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @option
- @item tri
- select triangular, linear slope (default)
- @item qsin
- select quarter of sine wave
- @item hsin
- select half of sine wave
- @item esin
- select exponential sine wave
- @item log
- select logarithmic
- @item ipar
- select inverted parabola
- @item qua
- select quadratic
- @item cub
- select cubic
- @item squ
- select square root
- @item cbr
- select cubic root
- @item par
- select parabola
- @item exp
- select exponential
- @item iqsin
- select inverted quarter of sine wave
- @item ihsin
- select inverted half of sine wave
- @item dese
- select double-exponential seat
- @item desi
- select double-exponential sigmoid
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
- @example
- afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
- @example
- afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section afftfilt
- Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
-
- @table @option
- @item real
- Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
- by '|'. Default is "1".
- If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
- expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
- output channels.
-
- @item imag
- Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
- separated by '|'. If not set, @var{real} option is used.
-
- Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
- constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item sr
- sample rate
-
- @item b
- current frequency bin number
-
- @item nb
- number of available bins
-
- @item ch
- channel number of the current expression
-
- @item chs
- number of channels
-
- @item pts
- current frame pts
- @end table
-
- @item win_size
- Set window size.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item w16
- @item w32
- @item w64
- @item w128
- @item w256
- @item w512
- @item w1024
- @item w2048
- @item w4096
- @item w8192
- @item w16384
- @item w32768
- @item w65536
- @end table
- Default is @code{w4096}
-
- @item win_func
- Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
-
- @item overlap
- Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
- window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
- @example
- afftfilt="1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1)"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{aformat}
- @section aformat
-
- Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
- negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item sample_fmts
- A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
-
- @item sample_rates
- A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
-
- @item channel_layouts
- A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
-
- See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the required syntax.
- @end table
-
- If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
-
- Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
- @example
- aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
- @end example
-
- @section agate
-
- A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
- processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
-
- Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
- and divide it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
- floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
- would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
- time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
-
- @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
- before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
- has to raise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
- Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input level before filtering.
- Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item range
- Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
- Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
-
- @item threshold
- If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
- Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
-
- @item ratio
- Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
- Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
-
- @item attack
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
- reduction stops.
- Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
-
- @item release
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
- reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
- Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
-
- @item makeup
- Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
- Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
-
- @item knee
- Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
- Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
-
- @item detection
- Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
- Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
-
- @item link
- Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
- the reduction.
- Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
- @end table
-
- @section alimiter
-
- The limiter prevents input signal from raising over a desired threshold.
- This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
- It means that there is a small delay after signal is processed. Keep in mind
- that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input gain. Default is 1.
-
- @item level_out
- Set output gain. Default is 1.
-
- @item limit
- Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
-
- @item attack
- The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
- milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
-
- @item release
- Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
- Default is 50 milliseconds.
-
- @item asc
- When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
- average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
- time.
-
- @item asc_level
- Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
- in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
-
- @item level
- Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
- This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
- @end table
-
- Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
- with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
-
- @section allpass
-
- Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
- @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
- An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
- without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set frequency in Hz.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{amerge}
- @section amerge
-
- Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item inputs
- Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
-
- @end table
-
- If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
- the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
- will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
- disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
- the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
- the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
- channels.
-
- For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
- is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
- following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
- first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
-
- On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
- in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
- arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
-
- All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
-
- If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
- shortest.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
- @example
- amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
- @end example
-
- @item
- Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section amix
-
- Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
-
- Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
- and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
- input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
- inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
-
- For example
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
- @end example
- will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
- first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item inputs
- The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
-
- @item duration
- How to determine the end-of-stream.
- @table @option
-
- @item longest
- The duration of the longest input. (default)
-
- @item shortest
- The duration of the shortest input.
-
- @item first
- The duration of the first input.
-
- @end table
-
- @item dropout_transition
- The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
- stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
-
- @end table
-
- @section anequalizer
-
- High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item params
-
- This option string is in format:
- "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
- Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
-
- @table @option
- @item chn
- Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
- If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
-
- @item cf
- Set central frequency for band.
- If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
-
- @item w
- Set band width in hertz.
-
- @item g
- Set band gain in dB.
-
- @item f
- Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
-
- @table @samp
- @item 0
- Butterworth, this is default.
-
- @item 1
- Chebyshev type 1.
-
- @item 2
- Chebyshev type 2.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @item curves
- With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
- in video stream.
-
- @item size
- Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
-
- @item mgain
- Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
- Setting this to reasonable value allows to display gain which is derived from
- neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
- when both are activated.
-
- @item fscale
- Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
- Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
-
- @item colors
- Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
- This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
- Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
- for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
- @example
- anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item change
- Alter existing filter parameters.
- Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
-
- @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
- error is returned.
- @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
- @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
- @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
-
- Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
- asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
- @end table
-
- @section anull
-
- Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
-
- @section apad
-
- Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
-
- This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
- extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item packet_size
- Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
-
- @item pad_len
- Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
- value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
- exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
-
- @item whole_len
- Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
- the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
- the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
- with @option{pad_len}.
- @end table
-
- If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} option is
- set, the filter will add silence to the end of the input stream
- indefinitely.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
- @example
- apad=pad_len=1024
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
- the input with silence if required:
- @example
- apad=whole_len=10000
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
- video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
- until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
- option:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section aphaser
- Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
-
- A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
- The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
-
- A description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item in_gain
- Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
-
- @item out_gain
- Set output gain. Default is 0.74
-
- @item delay
- Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
-
- @item decay
- Set decay. Default is 0.4.
-
- @item speed
- Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
-
- @item type
- Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item triangular, t
- @item sinusoidal, s
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section apulsator
-
- Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
- But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
- of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
- different waveforms and shifted phases.
- This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
- channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
- The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
- An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
- in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
- an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
- phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
- sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
- the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
-
- @item level_out
- Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
-
- @item mode
- Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
- sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
-
- @item amount
- Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
-
- @item offset_l
- Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
-
- @item offset_r
- Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
-
- @item width
- Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
-
- @item timing
- Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
-
- @item bpm
- Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
- is set to bpm.
-
- @item ms
- Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
- is set to ms.
-
- @item hz
- Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
- if timing is set to hz.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{aresample}
- @section aresample
-
- Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
- libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
- automatically convert between its input and output.
-
- This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
- the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
- timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
-
- The filter accepts the syntax
- [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
- expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
- @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
- ffmpeg-resampler manual for the complete list of supported options.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
- @example
- aresample=44100
- @end example
-
- @item
- Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
- samples per second compensation:
- @example
- aresample=async=1000
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section asetnsamples
-
- Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
-
- The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
- the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
- signal its end.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item nb_out_samples, n
- Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
- intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
- Default value is 1024.
-
- @item pad, p
- If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
- that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
- previous ones. Default value is 1.
- @end table
-
- For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
- disable padding for the last frame, use:
- @example
- asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
- @end example
-
- @section asetrate
-
- Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
- This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item sample_rate, r
- Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
- @end table
-
- @section ashowinfo
-
- Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
- The input audio is not modified.
-
- The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
- @var{key}:@var{value}.
-
- The following values are shown in the output:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item pts
- The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
- depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
-
- @item pts_time
- The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
-
- @item pos
- position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
- unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
-
- @item fmt
- The sample format.
-
- @item chlayout
- The channel layout.
-
- @item rate
- The sample rate for the audio frame.
-
- @item nb_samples
- The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
-
- @item checksum
- The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
- audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
-
- @item plane_checksums
- A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{astats}
- @section astats
-
- Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
- Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
- where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
-
- It accepts the following option:
- @table @option
- @item length
- Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
- Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 10]}.
-
- @item metadata
-
- Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
- where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
- disabled.
-
- Available keys for each channel are:
- DC_offset
- Min_level
- Max_level
- Min_difference
- Max_difference
- Mean_difference
- Peak_level
- RMS_peak
- RMS_trough
- Crest_factor
- Flat_factor
- Peak_count
- Bit_depth
-
- and for Overall:
- DC_offset
- Min_level
- Max_level
- Min_difference
- Max_difference
- Mean_difference
- Peak_level
- RMS_level
- RMS_peak
- RMS_trough
- Flat_factor
- Peak_count
- Bit_depth
- Number_of_samples
-
- For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
- this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
-
- For description what each key means read below.
-
- @item reset
- Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
- Default is disabled.
- @end table
-
- A description of each shown parameter follows:
-
- @table @option
- @item DC offset
- Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
-
- @item Min level
- Minimal sample level.
-
- @item Max level
- Maximal sample level.
-
- @item Min difference
- Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
-
- @item Max difference
- Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
-
- @item Mean difference
- Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
- The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
-
- @item Peak level dB
- @item RMS level dB
- Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
-
- @item RMS peak dB
- @item RMS trough dB
- Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
-
- @item Crest factor
- Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
-
- @item Flat factor
- Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
- (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
-
- @item Peak count
- Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
- @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
-
- @item Bit depth
- Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
- @end table
-
- @section asyncts
-
- Synchronize audio data with timestamps by squeezing/stretching it and/or
- dropping samples/adding silence when needed.
-
- This filter is not built by default, please use @ref{aresample} to do squeezing/stretching.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item compensate
- Enable stretching/squeezing the data to make it match the timestamps. Disabled
- by default. When disabled, time gaps are covered with silence.
-
- @item min_delta
- The minimum difference between timestamps and audio data (in seconds) to trigger
- adding/dropping samples. The default value is 0.1. If you get an imperfect
- sync with this filter, try setting this parameter to 0.
-
- @item max_comp
- The maximum compensation in samples per second. Only relevant with compensate=1.
- The default value is 500.
-
- @item first_pts
- Assume that the first PTS should be this value. The time base is 1 / sample
- rate. This allows for padding/trimming at the start of the stream. By default,
- no assumption is made about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or
- trimming is done. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with
- silence if an audio stream starts after the video stream or to trim any samples
- with a negative PTS due to encoder delay.
-
- @end table
-
- @section atempo
-
- Adjust audio tempo.
-
- The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
- specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
- be in the [0.5, 2.0] range.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
- @example
- atempo=0.8
- @end example
-
- @item
- To speed up audio to 125% tempo:
- @example
- atempo=1.25
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section atrim
-
- Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item start
- Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
- sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
-
- @item end
- Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
- audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
- the last sample in the output.
-
- @item start_pts
- Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
- instead of seconds.
-
- @item end_pts
- Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
- of seconds.
-
- @item duration
- The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
-
- @item start_sample
- The number of the first sample that should be output.
-
- @item end_sample
- The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
- @end table
-
- @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
- duration specifications; see
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
- option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
- samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
- give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
- zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
- to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
- atrim filter.
-
- If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
- keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
- only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
- filters.
-
- The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
- just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
-
- Examples:
- @itemize
- @item
- Drop everything except the second minute of input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
- @end example
-
- @item
- Keep only the first 1000 samples:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section bandpass
-
- Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
- frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
- The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
- instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
- The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
-
- @item csg
- Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
- @end table
-
- @section bandreject
-
- Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
- frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
- The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
- @end table
-
- @section bass
-
- Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
- shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
- hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item gain, g
- Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
- (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
- Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
-
- @item frequency, f
- Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
- to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
- The default value is @code{100} Hz.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
- @end table
-
- @section biquad
-
- Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
- Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
- are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
-
- @section bs2b
- Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
- stereo audio records.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item profile
- Pre-defined crossfeed level.
- @table @option
-
- @item default
- Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
-
- @item cmoy
- Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
-
- @item jmeier
- Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
-
- @end table
-
- @item fcut
- Cut frequency (in Hz).
-
- @item feed
- Feed level (in Hz).
-
- @end table
-
- @section channelmap
-
- Remap input channels to new locations.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item channel_layout
- The channel layout of the output stream.
-
- @item map
- Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
- mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
- @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
- channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
- @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
- channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
- index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
- @end table
-
- If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
- output channels, preserving indices.
-
- For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
- @end example
- will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
- the input.
-
- To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
- @end example
-
- @section channelsplit
-
- Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item channel_layout
- The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
- @end table
-
- For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
- @end example
- will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
- the left channel and the other the right channel.
-
- Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
- 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
- -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
- front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
- side_right.wav
- @end example
-
- @section chorus
- Add a chorus effect to the audio.
-
- Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
-
- Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
- constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
- The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
- the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
- sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
- off key.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item in_gain
- Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
-
- @item out_gain
- Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
-
- @item delays
- Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
-
- @item decays
- Set decays.
-
- @item speeds
- Set speeds.
-
- @item depths
- Set depths.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- A single delay:
- @example
- chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Two delays:
- @example
- chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
- @example
- chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section compand
- Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item attacks
- @item decays
- A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
- of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
- increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
- situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
- shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
- loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
- a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
- If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
- set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
-
- @item points
- A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
- maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
- the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
- @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
-
- The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
- does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
- may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
- function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20}.
-
- @item soft-knee
- Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
-
- @item gain
- Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
- function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
- It defaults to 0.
-
- @item volume
- Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
- starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
- example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
- companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
- quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
-
- @item delay
- Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
- delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
- approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
- operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
- noisy environment:
- @example
- compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
- @end example
-
- Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
- @example
- compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
- @end example
-
- @item
- A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
- @example
- compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
- than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
- @example
- compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
- @end example
-
- @item
- 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
- @end example
-
- @item
- 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
- @end example
-
- @item
- 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
- @end example
-
- @item
- 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
- @end example
-
- @item
- 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Compressor/Gate:
- @example
- compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
- @end example
-
- @item
- Expander:
- @example
- compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
- @end example
-
- @item
- Hard limiter at -6dB:
- @example
- compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
- @end example
-
- @item
- Hard limiter at -12dB:
- @example
- compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
- @end example
-
- @item
- Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
- @example
- compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
- @end example
-
- @item
- Soft limiter:
- @example
- compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section compensationdelay
-
- Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
- positions of microphones or speakers.
-
- For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
- different location. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
- normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
- their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
- these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that distance of
- ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone to capture signal in
- antiphase to another microphone. That makes the final mix sounding moody.
- This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
- to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
-
- The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
- synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
- Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
- Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item mm
- Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
- Default is 0.
-
- @item cm
- Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
- Default is 0.
-
- @item m
- Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
- Default is 0.
-
- @item dry
- Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
- Default is 0.
-
- @item wet
- Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
- Default is 1.
-
- @item temp
- Set temperature degree in Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
- Default is 20.
- @end table
-
- @section dcshift
- Apply a DC shift to the audio.
-
- This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
- in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
- headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
- a signal has a DC offset.
-
- @table @option
- @item shift
- Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
- the audio.
-
- @item limitergain
- Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
- used to prevent clipping.
- @end table
-
- @section dynaudnorm
- Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
-
- This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
- to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
- contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
- Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
- This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
- while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
- The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
- sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
- same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
- this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
- of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
-
- @table @option
- @item f
- Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
- Default is 500 milliseconds.
- The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
- referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
- meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
- peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
- normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
- Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
- frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
- Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
- been found to give good results with most files.
- Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
- automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
-
- @item g
- Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
- number. Default is 31.
- Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
- @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
- is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
- simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
- takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
- the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
- smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
- adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
- effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
- In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
- Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
- contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
- Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
-
- @item p
- Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
- level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
- target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
- makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
- A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
- magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
- It is not recommended to go above this value.
-
- @item m
- Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
- The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
- factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
- result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
- the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
- additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
- (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
- factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
- factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
- it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
- with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
- higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
- not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
- Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
- gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
- value.
-
- @item r
- Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
- By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
- This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
- (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
- be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
- level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
- Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
- abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
- determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
- that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
- just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
- frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
- established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
- factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
- Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
- frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
-
- @item n
- Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
- By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
- amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
- the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
- However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
- channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
- In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
- the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
- only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
- harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
-
- @item c
- Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
- An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
- In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
- -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
- audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
- That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
- single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
- value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
- 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
- DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
- Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
- With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
- the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
- that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
- are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
- boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
- between neighbouring frames.
-
- @item b
- Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
- The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
- around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
- subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
- beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
- frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
- file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
- frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
- question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
- in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
- to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
- of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
- "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
-
- @item s
- Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
- By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
- compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
- full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
- in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
- normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
- For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
- (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
- all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
- to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
- going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
- However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
- value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
- frame.
- In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
- Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
- @end table
-
- @section earwax
-
- Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
-
- This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
- so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
- inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
- the listener (standard for speakers).
-
- Ported from SoX.
-
- @section equalizer
-
- Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
- filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
- be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
- filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
-
- In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
- be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
-
- @item gain, g
- Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
- Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
- @itemize
- @item
- Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
- @example
- equalizer=f=1000:width_type=h:width=200:g=-10
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
- @example
- equalizer=f=1000:width_type=q:width=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:width_type=q:width=2:g=-5
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section extrastereo
-
- Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
- adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item m
- Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
- (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
- -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
-
- @item c
- Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
- @end table
-
- @section firequalizer
- Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item gain
- Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
- @table @option
- @item f
- the evaluated frequency
- @item sr
- sample rate
- @item ch
- channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
- @item chid
- channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
- multichannels evaluation is disabled
- @item chs
- number of channels
- @item chlayout
- channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
-
- @end table
- and functions:
- @table @option
- @item gain_interpolate(f)
- interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
- @end table
- This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
-
- @item gain_entry
- Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
- contain functions:
- @table @option
- @item entry(f, g)
- store gain entry at frequency f with value g
- @end table
- This option is also available as command.
-
- @item delay
- Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
- Default is @code{0.01}.
-
- @item accuracy
- Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
- Default is @code{5}.
-
- @item wfunc
- Set window function. Acceptable values are:
- @table @option
- @item rectangular
- rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
- @item hann
- hann window (default)
- @item hamming
- hamming window
- @item blackman
- blackman window
- @item nuttall3
- 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
- @item mnuttall3
- minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
- @item nuttall
- 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
- @item bnuttall
- minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
- @item bharris
- blackman-harris window
- @end table
-
- @item fixed
- If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
- filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
-
- @item multi
- Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
-
- @item zero_phase
- Enable zero phase mode by substracting timestamp to compensate delay.
- Default is disabled.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
- @itemize
- @item
- lowpass at 1000 Hz:
- @example
- firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
- @end example
- @item
- lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
- @example
- firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
- @end example
- @item
- custom equalization:
- @example
- firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
- @end example
- @item
- higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
- @example
- firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
- @end example
- @item
- lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
- @example
- firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
- :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section flanger
- Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item delay
- Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
-
- @item depth
- Set added swep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
-
- @item regen
- Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
- Default value is 0.
-
- @item width
- Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
- Default value is 71.
-
- @item speed
- Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
-
- @item shape
- Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
- Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
-
- @item phase
- Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
- Default value is 25.
-
- @item interp
- Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
- Default is @var{linear}.
- @end table
-
- @section highpass
-
- Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
- The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
- The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
-
- @item poles, p
- Set number of poles. Default is 2.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
- Applies only to double-pole filter.
- The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
- @end table
-
- @section join
-
- Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item inputs
- The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
-
- @item channel_layout
- The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
-
- @item map
- Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
- mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
- form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
- can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
- index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
- channel.
- @end table
-
- The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
- explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
- and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
-
- Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
- 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
- out
- @end example
-
- @section ladspa
-
- Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-ladspa}.
-
- @table @option
- @item file, f
- Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
- variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
- each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
- @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
- this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
- @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
-
- @item plugin, p
- Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
- one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
- will list all available plugins within the specified library.
-
- @item controls, c
- Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
- values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
- threshold or gain).
- Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
- c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
- @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
- Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
- @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
- @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
- If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
- their valid ranges are printed.
-
- @item sample_rate, s
- Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
- zero inputs.
-
- @item nb_samples, n
- Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
- is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
-
- @item duration, d
- Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
- Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
- as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
- If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
- supposed to be generated forever.
- Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
- @example
- ladspa=file=amp
- @end example
-
- @item
- List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
- plugin from @code{VCF} library:
- @example
- ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
- @end example
-
- @item
- Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
- plugin library:
- @example
- ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
- @end example
-
- @item
- Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
- (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
- @example
- ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
- @example
- ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
- @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
- @example
- ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
- @example
- ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
- @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
- @example
- ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
- @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
- @example
- ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item cN
- Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
-
- If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
- @end table
-
- @section loudnorm
-
- EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
- Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
- This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libebur128}.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item I, i
- Set integrated loudness target.
- Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
-
- @item LRA, lra
- Set loudness range target.
- Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
-
- @item TP, tp
- Set maximum true peak.
- Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
-
- @item measured_I, measured_i
- Measured IL of input file.
- Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
-
- @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
- Measured LRA of input file.
- Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
-
- @item measured_TP, measured_tp
- Measured true peak of input file.
- Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
-
- @item measured_thresh
- Measured threshold of input file.
- Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
-
- @item offset
- Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
- Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
-
- @item linear
- Normalize linearly if possible.
- measured_I, measured_LRA, measured_TP, and measured_thresh must also
- to be specified in order to use this mode.
- Options are true or false. Default is true.
-
- @item dual_mono
- Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
- on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
- If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
- Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
- Options are true or false. Default is false.
-
- @item print_format
- Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
- Default value is none.
- @end table
-
- @section lowpass
-
- Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
- The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
- The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item frequency, f
- Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
-
- @item poles, p
- Set number of poles. Default is 2.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
- Applies only to double-pole filter.
- The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{pan}
- @section pan
-
- Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
- channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
-
- This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
- stream.
-
- The filter accepts parameters of the form:
- "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
-
- @table @option
- @item l
- output channel layout or number of channels
-
- @item outdef
- output channel specification, of the form:
- "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[+[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
-
- @item out_name
- output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
- number (c0, c1, etc.)
-
- @item gain
- multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
-
- @item in_name
- input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
- named and numbered input channels
- @end table
-
- If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
- that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
- avoiding clipping noise.
-
- @subsection Mixing examples
-
- For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
- factor for the left channel:
- @example
- pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
- @end example
-
- A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
- 7-channels surround:
- @example
- pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
- @end example
-
- Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
- that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
- needs.
-
- @subsection Remapping examples
-
- The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
-
- @itemize
- @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
- @item only one input per channel output,
- @end itemize
-
- If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
- channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
- remapping.
-
- For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
- dropping the extra channels:
- @example
- pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
- @end example
-
- Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
- and keep the input channel layout:
- @example
- pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
- @end example
-
- If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
- still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
- @example
- pan="stereo|c1=c1"
- @end example
-
- Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
- front left and right:
- @example
- pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
- @end example
-
- @section replaygain
-
- ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
- outputs it unchanged.
- At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
-
- @section resample
-
- Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
- not meant to be used directly.
-
- @section rubberband
- Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item tempo
- Set tempo scale factor.
-
- @item pitch
- Set pitch scale factor.
-
- @item transients
- Set transients detector.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item crisp
- @item mixed
- @item smooth
- @end table
-
- @item detector
- Set detector.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item compound
- @item percussive
- @item soft
- @end table
-
- @item phase
- Set phase.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item laminar
- @item independent
- @end table
-
- @item window
- Set processing window size.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item standard
- @item short
- @item long
- @end table
-
- @item smoothing
- Set smoothing.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item off
- @item on
- @end table
-
- @item formant
- Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item shifted
- @item preserved
- @end table
-
- @item pitchq
- Set pitch quality.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item quality
- @item speed
- @item consistency
- @end table
-
- @item channels
- Set channels.
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item apart
- @item together
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section sidechaincompress
-
- This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
- detected signal using second input signal.
- It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
- First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
- The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
- processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
-
- @item threshold
- If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
- reduction of first stream.
- By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
-
- @item ratio
- Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
- raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
- Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
-
- @item attack
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
- reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
-
- @item release
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
- reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
-
- @item makeup
- Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
- Default is 2. Range is from 1 and 64.
-
- @item knee
- Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
- Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
-
- @item link
- Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
- or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
- reduction. Default is @code{average}.
-
- @item detection
- Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
- of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
-
- @item level_sc
- Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
-
- @item mix
- How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
- Range is between 0 and 1.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
- depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
- merged with 2nd input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section sidechaingate
-
- A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
- filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
- Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
- threshold.
- For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
- the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
- appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
- natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
- guitar.
- It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
- First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input level before filtering.
- Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item range
- Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
- Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
-
- @item threshold
- If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
- Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
-
- @item ratio
- Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
- Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
-
- @item attack
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
- reduction stops.
- Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
-
- @item release
- Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
- reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
- Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
-
- @item makeup
- Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
- Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
-
- @item knee
- Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
- Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
-
- @item detection
- Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
- Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
-
- @item link
- Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
- the reduction.
- Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
-
- @item level_sc
- Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
- @end table
-
- @section silencedetect
-
- Detect silence in an audio stream.
-
- This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
- or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
- minimum detected noise duration.
-
- The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item duration, d
- Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
-
- @item noise, n
- Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
- specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
- @example
- silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
- tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section silenceremove
-
- Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item start_periods
- This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
- the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
- beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
- finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
- the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
- values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
- Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item start_duration
- Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
- trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
- as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item start_threshold
- This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
- audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
- you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
- Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
- or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item stop_periods
- Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
- To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
- that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
- used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
- @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
- in the middle of the audio.
- Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item stop_duration
- Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
- more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
- the audio.
- Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item stop_threshold
- This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
- the end of audio.
- Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
- or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item leave_silence
- This indicate that @var{stop_duration} length of audio should be left intact
- at the beginning of each period of silence.
- For example, if you want to remove long pauses between words but do not want
- to remove the pauses completely. Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item detection
- Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
- and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
- Default value is @code{rms}.
-
- @item window
- Set ratio used to calculate size of window for detecting silence.
- Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
- that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
- pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
- @example
- silenceremove=1:5:0.02
- @end example
-
- @item
- Trim all silence encountered from begining to end where there is more than 1
- second of silence in audio:
- @example
- silenceremove=0:0:0:-1:1:-90dB
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section sofalizer
-
- SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
- loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
- formats up to 9 channels supported).
- The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
- SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
- Austrian Academy of Sciences.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-netcdf}.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item sofa
- Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
-
- @item gain
- Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
-
- @item rotation
- Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
-
- @item elevation
- Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
-
- @item radius
- Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
- HRTFs. Default is 1.
-
- @item type
- Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
- processing audio in time domain which is slow.
- @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
- Default is @var{freq}.
-
- @item speakers
- Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
- <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
- Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
- azimuth and elevation in degreees.
- Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
- For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
- 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
- Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
- @example
- sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
- @example
- sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, rear left and rear right
- and also with custom gain:
- @example
- "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|RL 135|RR 225:gain=28"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section stereotools
-
- This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
- M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
- or spreading the stereo image of master track.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_in
- Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
- Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item level_out
- Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
- Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item balance_in
- Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
- Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
-
- @item balance_out
- Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
- Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
-
- @item softclip
- Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
- clipping. Disabled by default.
-
- @item mutel
- Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
-
- @item muter
- Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
-
- @item phasel
- Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
-
- @item phaser
- Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
-
- @item mode
- Set stereo mode. Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item lr>lr
- Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
-
- @item lr>ms
- Left/Right to Mid/Side.
-
- @item ms>lr
- Mid/Side to Left/Right.
-
- @item lr>ll
- Left/Right to Left/Left.
-
- @item lr>rr
- Left/Right to Right/Right.
-
- @item lr>l+r
- Left/Right to Left + Right.
-
- @item lr>rl
- Left/Right to Right/Left.
- @end table
-
- @item slev
- Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
- Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item sbal
- Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
- Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
-
- @item mlev
- Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
- Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
-
- @item mpan
- Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
-
- @item base
- Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
- Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
-
- @item delay
- Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
- vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
-
- @item sclevel
- Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
-
- @item phase
- Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply karaoke like effect:
- @example
- stereotools=mlev=0.015625
- @end example
-
- @item
- Convert M/S signal to L/R:
- @example
- "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section stereowiden
-
- This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
- channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
- thereby widening the stereo effect.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item delay
- Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
- Default is 20 milliseconds.
-
- @item feedback
- Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
- effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
- effect. Default is 0.3.
-
- @item crossfeed
- Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
- the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
- channels. Default is 0.3.
-
- @item drymix
- Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
- @end table
-
- @section scale_npp
-
- Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
- format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
- works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
-
- The following additional options are accepted:
- @table @option
- @item format
- The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
- default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
- and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
-
- @item interp_algo
- The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
- @table @option
- @item nn
- Nearest neighbour.
-
- @item linear
- @item cubic
- @item cubic2p_bspline
- 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
-
- @item cubic2p_catmullrom
- 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
-
- @item cubic2p_b05c03
- 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
-
- @item super
- Supersampling
-
- @item lanczos
- @end table
-
- @end table
-
- @section select
- Select frames to pass in output.
-
- @section treble
-
- Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
- shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
- hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item gain, g
- Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
- Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
- to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
-
- @item frequency, f
- Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
- to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
- The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
-
- @item width_type
- Set method to specify band-width of filter.
- @table @option
- @item h
- Hz
- @item q
- Q-Factor
- @item o
- octave
- @item s
- slope
- @end table
-
- @item width, w
- Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
- @end table
-
- @section tremolo
-
- Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item f
- Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
- (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
- This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
- a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
- Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
-
- @item d
- Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
- Default value is 0.5.
- @end table
-
- @section vibrato
-
- Sinusoidal phase modulation.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item f
- Modulation frequency in Hertz.
- Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
-
- @item d
- Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
- Default value is 0.5.
- @end table
-
- @section volume
-
- Adjust the input audio volume.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item volume
- Set audio volume expression.
-
- Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
-
- The output audio volume is given by the relation:
- @example
- @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
- @end example
-
- The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
-
- @item precision
- This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
-
- It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
- precision of the volume scaling.
-
- @table @option
- @item fixed
- 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
- @item float
- 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
- @item double
- 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
- @end table
-
- @item replaygain
- Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
-
- @table @option
- @item drop
- Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
-
- @item ignore
- Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
-
- @item track
- Prefer the track gain, if present.
-
- @item album
- Prefer the album gain, if present.
- @end table
-
- @item replaygain_preamp
- Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
-
- Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
-
- @item eval
- Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item once
- only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
- when the @samp{volume} command is sent
-
- @item frame
- evaluate expression for each incoming frame
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{once}.
- @end table
-
- The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- frame number (starting at zero)
- @item nb_channels
- number of channels
- @item nb_consumed_samples
- number of samples consumed by the filter
- @item nb_samples
- number of samples in the current frame
- @item pos
- original frame position in the file
- @item pts
- frame PTS
- @item sample_rate
- sample rate
- @item startpts
- PTS at start of stream
- @item startt
- time at start of stream
- @item t
- frame time
- @item tb
- timestamp timebase
- @item volume
- last set volume value
- @end table
-
- Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
- @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
- variables will evaluate to NAN.
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item volume
- Modify the volume expression.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @item replaygain_noclip
- Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
-
- Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Halve the input audio volume:
- @example
- volume=volume=0.5
- volume=volume=1/2
- volume=volume=-6.0206dB
- @end example
-
- In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
- omitted, for example like in:
- @example
- volume=0.5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
- @example
- volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
- @example
- volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section volumedetect
-
- Detect the volume of the input video.
-
- The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
- the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
-
- In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
- volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
- registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
- the samples).
-
- All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- Here is an excerpt of the output:
- @example
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
- [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
- @end example
-
- It means that:
- @itemize
- @item
- The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
- @item
- The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
- @item
- There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
- @end itemize
-
- In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
- raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
-
- @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
-
- @chapter Audio Sources
- @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
-
- Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
-
- @section abuffer
-
- Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
-
- This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
- through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item time_base
- The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
- either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
-
- @item sample_rate
- The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
-
- @item sample_fmt
- The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
- Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
- the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
-
- @item channel_layout
- The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
- Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
- @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
- from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
-
- @item channels
- The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
- If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
- must be consistent.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @example
- abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
- @end example
-
- will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
- Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
- 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
- equivalent to:
- @example
- abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
- @end example
-
- @section aevalsrc
-
- Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
-
- This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
- channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
- audio signal.
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item exprs
- Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
- @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
- depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
- specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
-
- @item channel_layout, c
- Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
- must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
-
- @item duration, d
- Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
- Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
- duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
- complete frame.
-
- If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
- supposed to be generated forever.
-
- @item nb_samples, n
- Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
- default to 1024.
-
- @item sample_rate, s
- Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
- @end table
-
- Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
-
- @item t
- time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
-
- @item s
- sample rate
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Generate silence:
- @example
- aevalsrc=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
- 8000 Hz:
- @example
- aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
- Center + Back Center) explicitly:
- @example
- aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate white noise:
- @example
- aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
- @example
- aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
- @example
- aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section anullsrc
-
- The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
- as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
- the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
- synth filter).
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item channel_layout, cl
-
- Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
- representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
- is "stereo".
-
- Check the channel_layout_map definition in
- @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
- channel layout values.
-
- @item sample_rate, r
- Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
-
- @item nb_samples, n
- Set the number of samples per requested frames.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
- @example
- anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
- @end example
-
- @item
- Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
- @example
- anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
-
- @section flite
-
- Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libflite}.
-
- Note that the flite library is not thread-safe.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item list_voices
- If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
- immediately. Default value is 0.
-
- @item nb_samples, n
- Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
-
- @item textfile
- Set the filename containing the text to speak.
-
- @item text
- Set the text to speak.
-
- @item voice, v
- Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
- @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
- standard flite voice:
- @example
- flite=textfile=speech.txt
- @end example
-
- @item
- Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
- @example
- flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
- @end example
-
- @item
- Input text to ffmpeg:
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
- the @code{lavfi} device:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- For more information about libflite, check:
- @url{http://www.speech.cs.cmu.edu/flite/}
-
- @section anoisesrc
-
- Generate a noise audio signal.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item sample_rate, r
- Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
-
- @item amplitude, a
- Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
- is 1.0.
-
- @item duration, d
- Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
- results in noise with an infinite length.
-
- @item color, colour, c
- Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, and brown.
- Default color is white.
-
- @item seed, s
- Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
-
- @item nb_samples, n
- Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
- @example
- anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section sine
-
- Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
-
- The audio signal is bit-exact.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item frequency, f
- Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
-
- @item beep_factor, b
- Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
- the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
-
- @item sample_rate, r
- Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
-
- @item duration, d
- Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
-
- @item samples_per_frame
- Set the number of samples per output frame.
-
- The expression can contain the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item pts
- The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
- expressed in @var{TB} units.
-
- @item t
- The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
-
- @item TB
- The timebase of the output audio frames.
- @end table
-
- Default is @code{1024}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
- @example
- sine
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
- @example
- sine=220:4:d=5
- sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
- sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
- pattern:
- @example
- sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
-
- @chapter Audio Sinks
- @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
-
- Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
-
- @section abuffersink
-
- Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
-
- This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
- through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
- or the options system.
-
- It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
- defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
- parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
- @section anullsink
-
- Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
- mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
- tools.
-
- @c man end AUDIO SINKS
-
- @chapter Video Filters
- @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
-
- When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
- existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
- The configure output will show the video filters included in your
- build.
-
- Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
-
- @section alphaextract
-
- Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
- is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
-
- @section alphamerge
-
- Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
- grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
- @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
- sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
- channel.
-
- For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
- and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
- @example
- movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
- @end example
-
- Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
- sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
- input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
- pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
- overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
-
- @section ass
-
- Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
- and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
- Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
-
- This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
- the @ref{subtitles} filter:
-
- @table @option
- @item shaping
- Set the shaping engine
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
- @item simple
- Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
- @item complex
- Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
- @end table
-
- The default is @code{auto}.
- @end table
-
- @section atadenoise
- Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0a
- Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
- Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
-
- @item 0b
- Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
- Valid range is 0 to 5.
-
- @item 1a
- Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
- Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
-
- @item 1b
- Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
- Valid range is 0 to 5.
-
- @item 2a
- Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
- Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
-
- @item 2b
- Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
- Valid range is 0 to 5.
-
- Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
- threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
-
- @item s
- Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 33. Must be odd
- number in range [5, 129].
- @end table
-
- @section bbox
-
- Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
- luminance plane.
-
- This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
- luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
- The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
- log.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item min_val
- Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
- @end table
-
- @section blackdetect
-
- Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
- useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
- recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
- duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
-
- In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
- least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item black_min_duration, d
- Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
- be a non-negative floating point number.
-
- Default value is 2.0.
-
- @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
- Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
- Express the minimum value for the ratio:
- @example
- @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
- @end example
-
- for which a picture is considered black.
- Default value is 0.98.
-
- @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
- Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
-
- The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
- pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
- the following equation:
- @example
- @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
- @end example
-
- @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
- the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
- formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
-
- Default value is 0.10.
- @end table
-
- The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
- value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
- @example
- blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
- @end example
-
- @section blackframe
-
- Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
- detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
- the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
- the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
-
- In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
- least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item amount
- The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
- @code{98}.
-
- @item threshold, thresh
- The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
- @code{32}.
-
- @end table
-
- @section blend, tblend
-
- Blend two video frames into each other.
-
- The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
- stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
- "bottom" layer. Output terminates when shortest input terminates.
-
- The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
- from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
- the new frame on top of the old frame.
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item c0_mode
- @item c1_mode
- @item c2_mode
- @item c3_mode
- @item all_mode
- Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
- of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
-
- Available values for component modes are:
- @table @samp
- @item addition
- @item addition128
- @item and
- @item average
- @item burn
- @item darken
- @item difference
- @item difference128
- @item divide
- @item dodge
- @item freeze
- @item exclusion
- @item glow
- @item hardlight
- @item hardmix
- @item heat
- @item lighten
- @item linearlight
- @item multiply
- @item multiply128
- @item negation
- @item normal
- @item or
- @item overlay
- @item phoenix
- @item pinlight
- @item reflect
- @item screen
- @item softlight
- @item subtract
- @item vividlight
- @item xor
- @end table
-
- @item c0_opacity
- @item c1_opacity
- @item c2_opacity
- @item c3_opacity
- @item all_opacity
- Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
- of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
-
- @item c0_expr
- @item c1_expr
- @item c2_expr
- @item c3_expr
- @item all_expr
- Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
- of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
-
- The expressions can use the following variables:
-
- @table @option
- @item N
- The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
-
- @item X
- @item Y
- the coordinates of the current sample
-
- @item W
- @item H
- the width and height of currently filtered plane
-
- @item SW
- @item SH
- Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
- ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
- plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
- @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
-
- @item T
- Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
-
- @item TOP, A
- Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
-
- @item BOTTOM, B
- Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
- @end table
-
- @item shortest
- Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is
- @code{0}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
-
- @item repeatlast
- Continue applying the last bottom frame after the end of the stream. A value of
- @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the bottom layer is reached.
- Default is @code{1}. This option is only defined for the @code{blend} filter.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
- @example
- blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
- @example
- blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply uncover left effect:
- @example
- blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply uncover down effect:
- @example
- blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply uncover up-left effect:
- @example
- blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
- @example
- blend=all_expr=if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
- @example
- tblend=all_mode=difference128
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section boxblur
-
- Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item luma_radius, lr
- @item luma_power, lp
- @item chroma_radius, cr
- @item chroma_power, cp
- @item alpha_radius, ar
- @item alpha_power, ap
-
- @end table
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_radius, lr
- @item chroma_radius, cr
- @item alpha_radius, ar
- Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
- corresponding input plane.
-
- The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
- greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
- luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
- planes.
-
- Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
- @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
- corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
-
- The expressions can contain the following constants:
- @table @option
- @item w
- @item h
- The input width and height in pixels.
-
- @item cw
- @item ch
- The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
- pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
- @end table
-
- @item luma_power, lp
- @item chroma_power, cp
- @item alpha_power, ap
- Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
- corresponding plane.
-
- Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
- @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
- corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
-
- A value of 0 will disable the effect.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
- set to 2:
- @example
- boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
- boxblur=2:1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
- @example
- boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
- @example
- boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section bwdif
-
- Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
- Deinterlacing Filter").
-
- Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
- interpolation algorithms.
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode
- The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, send_frame
- Output one frame for each frame.
- @item 1, send_field
- Output one frame for each field.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{send_field}.
-
- @item parity
- The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
- of the following values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, tff
- Assume the top field is first.
- @item 1, bff
- Assume the bottom field is first.
- @item -1, auto
- Enable automatic detection of field parity.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{auto}.
- If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
- top field first will be assumed.
-
- @item deint
- Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
- values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, all
- Deinterlace all frames.
- @item 1, interlaced
- Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{all}.
- @end table
-
- @section chromakey
- YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item color
- The color which will be replaced with transparency.
-
- @item similarity
- Similarity percentage with the key color.
-
- 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
-
- @item blend
- Blend percentage.
-
- 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
-
- Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
- the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
-
- @item yuv
- Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
-
- Litteral colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
- This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
- @end example
-
- @item
- Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section ciescope
-
- Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
-
- The filter acccepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item system
- Set color system.
-
- @table @samp
- @item ntsc, 470m
- @item ebu, 470bg
- @item smpte
- @item 240m
- @item apple
- @item widergb
- @item cie1931
- @item rec709, hdtv
- @item uhdtv, rec2020
- @end table
-
- @item cie
- Set CIE system.
-
- @table @samp
- @item xyy
- @item ucs
- @item luv
- @end table
-
- @item gamuts
- Set what gamuts to draw.
-
- See @code{system} option for avaiable values.
-
- @item size, s
- Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
-
- @item intensity, i
- Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
-
- @item contrast
- Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
-
- @item corrgamma
- Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
-
- @item showwhite
- Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
-
- @item gamma
- Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
- @end table
-
- @section codecview
-
- Visualize information exported by some codecs.
-
- Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
- means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
- @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item mv
- Set motion vectors to visualize.
-
- Available flags for @var{mv} are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item pf
- forward predicted MVs of P-frames
- @item bf
- forward predicted MVs of B-frames
- @item bb
- backward predicted MVs of B-frames
- @end table
-
- @item qp
- Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
-
- @item mv_type, mvt
- Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
-
- Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item fp
- forward predicted MVs
- @item bp
- backward predicted MVs
- @end table
-
- @item frame_type, ft
- Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
-
- Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item if
- intra-coded frames (I-frames)
- @item pf
- predicted frames (P-frames)
- @item bf
- bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
- @example
- ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
- @end example
-
- @item
- Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
- @example
- ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section colorbalance
- Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
-
- The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
- regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
-
- A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
- value towards the complementary color.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item rs
- @item gs
- @item bs
- Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
-
- @item rm
- @item gm
- @item bm
- Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
-
- @item rh
- @item gh
- @item bh
- Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
-
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Add red color cast to shadows:
- @example
- colorbalance=rs=.3
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section colorkey
- RGB colorspace color keying.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item color
- The color which will be replaced with transparency.
-
- @item similarity
- Similarity percentage with the key color.
-
- 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
-
- @item blend
- Blend percentage.
-
- 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
-
- Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
- the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
- @end example
-
- @item
- Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
- @example
- ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section colorlevels
-
- Adjust video input frames using levels.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item rimin
- @item gimin
- @item bimin
- @item aimin
- Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
-
- @item rimax
- @item gimax
- @item bimax
- @item aimax
- Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
-
- Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
- (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
-
- @item romin
- @item gomin
- @item bomin
- @item aomin
- Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
-
- @item romax
- @item gomax
- @item bomax
- @item aomax
- Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
-
- Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Make video output darker:
- @example
- colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase contrast:
- @example
- colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make video output lighter:
- @example
- colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase brightness:
- @example
- colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section colorchannelmixer
-
- Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
-
- This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
- the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
- modify is red, the output value will be:
- @example
- @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
- @end example
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item rr
- @item rg
- @item rb
- @item ra
- Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
- Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
-
- @item gr
- @item gg
- @item gb
- @item ga
- Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
- Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
-
- @item br
- @item bg
- @item bb
- @item ba
- Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
- Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
-
- @item ar
- @item ag
- @item ab
- @item aa
- Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
- Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
-
- Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Convert source to grayscale:
- @example
- colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
- @end example
- @item
- Simulate sepia tones:
- @example
- colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section colormatrix
-
- Convert color matrix.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item src
- @item dst
- Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
- specified.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bt709
- BT.709
-
- @item bt601
- BT.601
-
- @item smpte240m
- SMPTE-240M
-
- @item fcc
- FCC
-
- @item bt2020
- BT.2020
- @end table
- @end table
-
- For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
- @example
- colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
- @end example
-
- @section colorspace
-
- Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item all
- Specify all color properties at once.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bt470m
- BT.470M
-
- @item bt470bg
- BT.470BG
-
- @item bt601-6-525
- BT.601-6 525
-
- @item bt601-6-625
- BT.601-6 625
-
- @item bt709
- BT.709
-
- @item smpte170m
- SMPTE-170M
-
- @item smpte240m
- SMPTE-240M
-
- @item bt2020
- BT.2020
-
- @end table
-
- @item space
- Specify output colorspace.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bt709
- BT.709
-
- @item fcc
- FCC
-
- @item bt470bg
- BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
-
- @item smpte170m
- SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
-
- @item smpte240m
- SMPTE-240M
-
- @item bt2020ncl
- BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
-
- @end table
-
- @item trc
- Specify output transfer characteristics.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bt709
- BT.709
-
- @item gamma22
- Constant gamma of 2.2
-
- @item gamma28
- Constant gamma of 2.8
-
- @item smpte170m
- SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
-
- @item smpte240m
- SMPTE-240M
-
- @item bt2020-10
- BT.2020 for 10-bits content
-
- @item bt2020-12
- BT.2020 for 12-bits content
-
- @end table
-
- @item prm
- Specify output color primaries.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bt709
- BT.709
-
- @item bt470m
- BT.470M
-
- @item bt470bg
- BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
-
- @item smpte170m
- SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
-
- @item smpte240m
- SMPTE-240M
-
- @item bt2020
- BT.2020
-
- @end table
-
- @item rng
- Specify output color range.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item mpeg
- MPEG (restricted) range
-
- @item jpeg
- JPEG (full) range
-
- @end table
-
- @item format
- Specify output color format.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item yuv420p
- YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
-
- @item yuv420p10
- YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
-
- @item yuv420p12
- YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
-
- @item yuv422p
- YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
-
- @item yuv422p10
- YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
-
- @item yuv422p12
- YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
-
- @item yuv444p
- YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
-
- @item yuv444p10
- YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
-
- @item yuv444p12
- YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
-
- @end table
-
- @item fast
- Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
- significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
- compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
-
- @item dither
- Specify dithering mode.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item none
- No dithering
-
- @item fsb
- Floyd-Steinberg dithering
- @end table
-
- @item wpadapt
- Whitepoint adaptation mode.
-
- The accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item bradford
- Bradford whitepoint adaptation
-
- @item vonkries
- von Kries whitepoint adaptation
-
- @item identity
- identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
- @end table
-
- @end table
-
- The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
- primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
- is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
- also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
- format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
- input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
- should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
- log an error and no conversion will take place.
-
- For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
- @example
- colorspace=smpte240m
- @end example
-
- @section convolution
-
- Apply convolution 3x3 or 5x5 filter.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0m
- @item 1m
- @item 2m
- @item 3m
- Set matrix for each plane.
- Matrix is sequence of 9 or 25 signed integers.
-
- @item 0rdiv
- @item 1rdiv
- @item 2rdiv
- @item 3rdiv
- Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
-
- @item 0bias
- @item 1bias
- @item 2bias
- @item 3bias
- Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
- Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply sharpen:
- @example
- convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply blur:
- @example
- convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply edge enhance:
- @example
- convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply edge detect:
- @example
- convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply emboss:
- @example
- convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section copy
-
- Copy the input source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
- testing purposes.
-
- @anchor{coreimage}
- @section coreimage
- Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
-
- Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
- processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
- exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
- the respective OSX.
-
- There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
- large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
- with its options.
-
- The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
- @table @option
- @item list_filters
- List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
- options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
- values.
- @example
- list_filters=true
- @end example
-
- @item filter
- Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
- Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
- Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
- to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
- by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
- A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
- filter.
-
- It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
- All omitted options are used with their default values.
- The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
- @example
- filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
- @end example
-
- @item output_rect
- Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
- input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
- @example
- output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
- @end example
- If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
- The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
- image. Negative values are valid for each component.
- @example
- output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
- @end example
- @end table
-
- Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
- transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
- Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
- image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
- usable as intended.
-
- Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
- respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
- filter output has the same size as the input image.
-
- For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
- previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
- filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
- this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
- blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
- output image.
-
- The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
- which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
- images by another video source or an input video is not required.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- List all filters available:
- @example
- coreimage=list_filters=true
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
- @example
- coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
- its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
- @example
- coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
- given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section crop
-
- Crop the input video to given dimensions.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item w, out_w
- The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
- This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
- configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
-
- @item h, out_h
- The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
- This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
- configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
-
- @item x
- The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
- video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
- This expression is evaluated per-frame.
-
- @item y
- The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
- It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
- This expression is evaluated per-frame.
-
- @item keep_aspect
- If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
- to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
- ratio. It defaults to 0.
- @end table
-
- The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
- expressions containing the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item x
- @item y
- The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
- each new frame.
-
- @item in_w
- @item in_h
- The input width and height.
-
- @item iw
- @item ih
- These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
-
- @item out_w
- @item out_h
- The output (cropped) width and height.
-
- @item ow
- @item oh
- These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
-
- @item a
- same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
-
- @item sar
- input sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item n
- The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item pos
- the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
-
- @item t
- The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
-
- @end table
-
- The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
- and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
- cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
- evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
-
- The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
- position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
- are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
- is approximated to the nearest valid value.
-
- The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
- for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
- @example
- crop=100:100:12:34
- @end example
-
- Using named options, the example above becomes:
- @example
- crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
- @end example
-
- @item
- Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
- @example
- crop=100:100
- @end example
-
- @item
- Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
- @example
- crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
- @end example
-
- @item
- Crop the input video central square:
- @example
- crop=out_w=in_h
- crop=in_h
- @end example
-
- @item
- Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
- 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
- corner of the input image.
- @example
- crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
- @end example
-
- @item
- Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
- the top and bottom borders
- @example
- crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
- @end example
-
- @item
- Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
- @example
- crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
- @example
- crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply trembling effect:
- @example
- crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
- @example
- crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set x depending on the value of y:
- @example
- crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item w, out_w
- @item h, out_h
- @item x
- @item y
- Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
- in the input video.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @end table
-
- @section cropdetect
-
- Auto-detect the crop size.
-
- It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
- recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
- correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item limit
- Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
- from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
- value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
- You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
- on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
-
- @item round
- The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
- 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
- get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
- encoding to most video codecs.
-
- @item reset_count, reset
- Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
- reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
- detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
-
- This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
- indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
- playback.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{curves}
- @section curves
-
- Apply color adjustments using curves.
-
- This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
- component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
- tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
- values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
- the output frame.
-
- By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
- @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
- "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
-
- The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
- curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
- smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
- strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
- be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
- the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
-
- If there is no key point defined in @code{x=0}, the filter will automatically
- insert a @var{(0;0)} point. In the same way, if there is no key point defined
- in @code{x=1}, the filter will automatically insert a @var{(1;1)} point.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item preset
- Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
- to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
- options takes priority on the preset values.
- Available presets are:
- @table @samp
- @item none
- @item color_negative
- @item cross_process
- @item darker
- @item increase_contrast
- @item lighter
- @item linear_contrast
- @item medium_contrast
- @item negative
- @item strong_contrast
- @item vintage
- @end table
- Default is @code{none}.
- @item master, m
- Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
- is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
- @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
- post-processing LUT.
- @item red, r
- Set the key points for the red component.
- @item green, g
- Set the key points for the green component.
- @item blue, b
- Set the key points for the blue component.
- @item all
- Set the key points for all components (not including master).
- Can be used in addition to the other key points component
- options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
- @option{all} setting.
- @item psfile
- Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
- @end table
-
- To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
- defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
- @example
- curves=blue='0.5/0.58'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Vintage effect:
- @example
- curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0.50/0.48':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
- @end example
- Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
- @table @var
- @item red
- @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
- @item green
- @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
- @item blue
- @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
- @end table
-
- @item
- The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
- @example
- curves=preset=vintage
- @end example
-
- @item
- Or simply:
- @example
- curves=vintage
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
- @example
- curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0.45/0.53'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section datascope
-
- Video data analysis filter.
-
- This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Set output video size.
-
- @item x
- Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
-
- @item y
- Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
-
- @item mode
- Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
- @table @samp
- @item mono
- Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
-
- @item color
- Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
- background.
-
- @item color2
- Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
- the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
- @end table
-
- @item axis
- Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
- @end table
-
- @section dctdnoiz
-
- Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
-
- This filter is not designed for real time.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item sigma, s
- Set the noise sigma constant.
-
- This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
- coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
-
- If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
-
- Default is @code{0}.
-
- @item overlap
- Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
- may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
- risk of various artefacts.
-
- If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
- height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
-
- Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
-
- @item expr, e
- Set the coefficient factor expression.
-
- For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
- multiplier value for the coefficient.
-
- If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
-
- The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
- variable.
-
- @item n
- Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
- @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
-
- The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
- @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
- on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
- better de-noising.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
- @example
- dctdnoiz=4.5
- @end example
-
- The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
- @example
- dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
- @end example
-
- Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
- @example
- dctdnoiz=15:n=4
- @end example
-
- @section deband
-
- Remove banding artifacts from input video.
- It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item 1thr
- @item 2thr
- @item 3thr
- @item 4thr
- Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
- Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
- If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
- it will be considered as banded.
-
- @item range, r
- Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
- in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
- will be used.
- The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
-
- @item direction, d
- Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
- random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
- absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
- will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
- column.
-
- @item blur
- If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
- surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
- compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
- if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{decimate}
- @section decimate
-
- Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item cycle
- Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
- @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
- Default is @code{5}.
-
- @item dupthresh
- Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
- is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
- is @code{1.1}
-
- @item scthresh
- Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
-
- @item blockx
- @item blocky
- Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
- Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
- small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
-
- @item ppsrc
- Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
- stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
- the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
- @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
- stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
- @code{0}.
-
- @item chroma
- Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
- @code{1}.
- @end table
-
- @section deflate
-
- Apply deflate effect to the video.
-
- This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
- only values lower than the pixel.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item threshold0
- @item threshold1
- @item threshold2
- @item threshold3
- Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
- If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
- @end table
-
- @section dejudder
-
- Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
-
- Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
- source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
- will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
- container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
- rate video.
-
- The option available in this filter is:
- @table @option
-
- @item cycle
- Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
-
- Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
- @table @samp
-
- @item 4
- If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
-
- @item 5
- If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
-
- @item 20
- If a mixture of the two.
- @end table
-
- The default is @samp{4}.
- @end table
-
- @section delogo
-
- Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
- pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
- (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item x
- @item y
- Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
- specified.
-
- @item w
- @item h
- Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
- specified.
-
- @item band, t
- Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
- @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
- deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
- is not recommended.
-
- @item show
- When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
- finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
- The default value is 0.
-
- The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
- replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
- immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
- compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
- and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
- @example
- delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section deshake
-
- Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
- filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
- tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item x
- @item y
- @item w
- @item h
- Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
- vectors.
- If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
- rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
- and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
- filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
- box.
-
- This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
- might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
-
- If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
- then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
- without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
-
- Default - search the whole frame.
-
- @item rx
- @item ry
- Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
- range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
-
- @item edge
- Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
- frame. Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item blank, 0
- Fill zeroes at blank locations
- @item original, 1
- Original image at blank locations
- @item clamp, 2
- Extruded edge value at blank locations
- @item mirror, 3
- Mirrored edge at blank locations
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{mirror}.
-
- @item blocksize
- Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
- default 8.
-
- @item contrast
- Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
- the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
- pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
-
- @item search
- Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item exhaustive, 0
- Set exhaustive search
- @item less, 1
- Set less exhaustive search.
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
-
- @item filename
- If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
- specified file.
-
- @item opencl
- If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
- FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
-
- @end table
-
- @section detelecine
-
- Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
- pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
- to the telecine filter.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item first_field
- @table @samp
- @item top, t
- top field first
- @item bottom, b
- bottom field first
- The default value is @code{top}.
- @end table
-
- @item pattern
- A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
- The default value is @code{23}.
-
- @item start_frame
- A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
- pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
- @end table
-
- @section dilation
-
- Apply dilation effect to the video.
-
- This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item threshold0
- @item threshold1
- @item threshold2
- @item threshold3
- Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
- If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
-
- @item coordinates
- Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
- pixels are used.
-
- Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
-
- 1 2 3
- 4 5
- 6 7 8
- @end table
-
- @section displace
-
- Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
-
- It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
- source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
-
- The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
- x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
- along the y-axis.
- If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
- displacement map will be used.
-
- Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item edge
- Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item blank
- Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
-
- @item smear
- Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
-
- @item wrap
- Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
- @end table
- Default is @samp{smear}.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- @item
- Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section drawbox
-
- Draw a colored box on the input image.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item x
- @item y
- The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
-
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
- the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
-
- @item color, c
- Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
- check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
- value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
- video with inverted luma.
-
- @item thickness, t
- The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge. Default value is @code{3}.
-
- See below for the list of accepted constants.
- @end table
-
- The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
- following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item dar
- The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item in_h, ih
- @item in_w, iw
- The input width and height.
-
- @item sar
- The input sample aspect ratio.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
-
- @item w
- @item h
- The width and height of the drawn box.
-
- @item t
- The thickness of the drawn box.
-
- These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
- each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
- @example
- drawbox
- @end example
-
- @item
- Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
- @example
- drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
- @end example
-
- The previous example can be specified as:
- @example
- drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fill the box with pink color:
- @example
- drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=max
- @end example
-
- @item
- Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
- @example
- drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section drawgraph, adrawgraph
-
- Draw a graph using input video or audio metadata.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item m1
- Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
-
- @item fg1
- Set 1st foreground color expression.
-
- @item m2
- Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
-
- @item fg2
- Set 2nd foreground color expression.
-
- @item m3
- Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
-
- @item fg3
- Set 3rd foreground color expression.
-
- @item m4
- Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
-
- @item fg4
- Set 4th foreground color expression.
-
- @item min
- Set minimal value of metadata value.
-
- @item max
- Set maximal value of metadata value.
-
- @item bg
- Set graph background color. Default is white.
-
- @item mode
- Set graph mode.
-
- Available values for mode is:
- @table @samp
- @item bar
- @item dot
- @item line
- @end table
-
- Default is @code{line}.
-
- @item slide
- Set slide mode.
-
- Available values for slide is:
- @table @samp
- @item frame
- Draw new frame when right border is reached.
-
- @item replace
- Replace old columns with new ones.
-
- @item scroll
- Scroll from right to left.
-
- @item rscroll
- Scroll from left to right.
- @end table
-
- Default is @code{frame}.
-
- @item size
- Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- The default value is @code{900x256}.
-
- The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
- @table @option
- @item MIN
- Minimal value of metadata value.
-
- @item MAX
- Maximal value of metadata value.
-
- @item VAL
- Current metadata key value.
- @end table
-
- The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
- @end table
-
- Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
- @example
- signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
- @end example
-
- Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
- @example
- ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
- @end example
-
- @section drawgrid
-
- Draw a grid on the input image.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item x
- @item y
- The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
-
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
- input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
- framed. Default to 0.
-
- @item color, c
- Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
- check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special
- value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
- video with inverted luma.
-
- @item thickness, t
- The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
-
- See below for the list of accepted constants.
- @end table
-
- The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
- following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item dar
- The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item in_h, ih
- @item in_w, iw
- The input grid cell width and height.
-
- @item sar
- The input sample aspect ratio.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
-
- @item w
- @item h
- The width and height of the drawn cell.
-
- @item t
- The thickness of the drawn cell.
-
- These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
- each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
- @example
- drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
- @example
- drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{drawtext}
- @section drawtext
-
- Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
- libfreetype library.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
- To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
- configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
- To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
-
- @subsection Syntax
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item box
- Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
- The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
- The default value of @var{box} is 0.
-
- @item boxborderw
- Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
- The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
-
- @item boxcolor
- The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
- option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
-
- @item borderw
- Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
- The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
-
- @item bordercolor
- Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
- option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
-
- @item expansion
- Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
- @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
- @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
- below for details.
-
- @item fix_bounds
- If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
-
- @item fontcolor
- The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
- the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
-
- @item fontcolor_expr
- String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
- @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
- processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
-
- @item font
- The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
-
- @item fontfile
- The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
- This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
-
- @item draw
- This option does not exist, please see the timeline system
-
- @item alpha
- Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
- be either a number between 0.0 and 1.0
- The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} do.
- The default value is 1.
- Please see fontcolor_expr
-
- @item fontsize
- The font size to be used for drawing text.
- The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
-
- @item text_shaping
- If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
- right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
- Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
- By default 1 (if supported).
-
- @item ft_load_flags
- The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
-
- The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
- a combination of the following values:
- @table @var
- @item default
- @item no_scale
- @item no_hinting
- @item render
- @item no_bitmap
- @item vertical_layout
- @item force_autohint
- @item crop_bitmap
- @item pedantic
- @item ignore_global_advance_width
- @item no_recurse
- @item ignore_transform
- @item monochrome
- @item linear_design
- @item no_autohint
- @end table
-
- Default value is "default".
-
- For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
- libfreetype flags.
-
- @item shadowcolor
- The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
- syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
-
- @item shadowx
- @item shadowy
- The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
- position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
- values. The default value for both is "0".
-
- @item start_number
- The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
- is "0".
-
- @item tabsize
- The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
- Default value is 4.
-
- @item timecode
- Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
- format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
- option must be specified.
-
- @item timecode_rate, rate, r
- Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only).
-
- @item text
- The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
- encoded characters.
- This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
- @var{textfile}.
-
- @item textfile
- A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
- of UTF-8 encoded characters.
-
- This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
- parameter @var{text}.
-
- If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
-
- @item reload
- If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
- Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
- within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
- output image.
-
- The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
-
- See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
- @end table
-
- The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
- following constants and functions:
-
- @table @option
- @item dar
- input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item line_h, lh
- the height of each text line
-
- @item main_h, h, H
- the input height
-
- @item main_w, w, W
- the input width
-
- @item max_glyph_a, ascent
- the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
- coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
- glyphs.
- It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
- upwards.
-
- @item max_glyph_d, descent
- the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
- used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
- This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
- upwards.
-
- @item max_glyph_h
- maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
- contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
- @var{descent}.
-
- @item max_glyph_w
- maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
- contained in the rendered text
-
- @item n
- the number of input frame, starting from 0
-
- @item rand(min, max)
- return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
-
- @item sar
- The input sample aspect ratio.
-
- @item t
- timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
-
- @item text_h, th
- the height of the rendered text
-
- @item text_w, tw
- the width of the rendered text
-
- @item x
- @item y
- the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
-
- These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
- each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
- @subsection Text expansion
-
- If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
- the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
- expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
- feature is deprecated.
-
- If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
-
- If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
- the following expansion mechanism is used.
-
- The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
- the second character.
-
- Sequence of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
- braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
- If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
- they should be escaped.
-
- Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
- @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
- argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
- that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
- problems.
-
- The following functions are available:
-
- @table @command
-
- @item expr, e
- The expression evaluation result.
-
- It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
- which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
- @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
- example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
- the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
- value.
-
- @item expr_int_format, eif
- Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
-
- The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
- The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
- @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
- @code{printf} function.
- The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
- It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
-
- @item gmtime
- The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
- It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
-
- @item localtime
- The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
- It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
-
- @item metadata
- Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
-
- The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
-
- The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
- metadata key is not found or empty.
-
- @item n, frame_num
- The frame number, starting from 0.
-
- @item pict_type
- A 1 character description of the current picture type.
-
- @item pts
- The timestamp of the current frame.
- It can take up to three arguments.
-
- The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
- for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
- for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
- @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
- @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
- local time zone time.
-
- The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
-
- If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
- a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
- By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
- optional parameters.
-
- @example
- drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
- and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
- yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
- opacity of 20%.
-
- @example
- drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
- x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
- @end example
-
- Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
- within the parameter list.
-
- @item
- Show the text at the center of the video frame:
- @example
- drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
- @example
- drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
- frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
- with no newlines.
- @example
- drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
- @example
- drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
- The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
- @example
- drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
- @example
- drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
- @example
- drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
- @example
- drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
- @example
- #!/bin/sh
- DS=1.0 # display start
- DE=10.0 # display end
- FID=1.5 # fade in duration
- FOD=5 # fade out duration
- ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- For more information about libfreetype, check:
- @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
-
- For more information about fontconfig, check:
- @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
-
- For more information about libfribidi, check:
- @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
-
- @section edgedetect
-
- Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item low
- @item high
- Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
- algorithm.
-
- The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
- connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
- by the low threshold.
-
- @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
- [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
-
- Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
- is @code{50/255}.
-
- @item mode
- Define the drawing mode.
-
- @table @samp
- @item wires
- Draw white/gray wires on black background.
-
- @item colormix
- Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{wires}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
- @example
- edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
- @end example
-
- @item
- Painting effect without thresholding:
- @example
- edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section eq
- Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item contrast
- Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
- @code{-2.0} to @code{2.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item brightness
- Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
- range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
-
- @item saturation
- Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
- range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item gamma
- Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
- @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item gamma_r
- Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
- range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item gamma_g
- Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
- @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item gamma_b
- Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
- @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
-
- @item gamma_weight
- Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
- of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
- getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
- in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
- gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
- full strength. Default is "1".
-
- @item eval
- Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
- gamma expressions are evaluated.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item init
- only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
- when a command is processed
-
- @item frame
- evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{init}.
- @end table
-
- The expressions accept the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item n
- frame count of the input frame starting from 0
-
- @item pos
- byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
- unspecified
-
- @item r
- frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
-
- @item t
- timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
- @end table
-
- @subsection Commands
- The filter supports the following commands:
-
- @table @option
- @item contrast
- Set the contrast expression.
-
- @item brightness
- Set the brightness expression.
-
- @item saturation
- Set the saturation expression.
-
- @item gamma
- Set the gamma expression.
-
- @item gamma_r
- Set the gamma_r expression.
-
- @item gamma_g
- Set gamma_g expression.
-
- @item gamma_b
- Set gamma_b expression.
-
- @item gamma_weight
- Set gamma_weight expression.
-
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
-
- @end table
-
- @section erosion
-
- Apply erosion effect to the video.
-
- This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item threshold0
- @item threshold1
- @item threshold2
- @item threshold3
- Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
- If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
-
- @item coordinates
- Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
- pixels are used.
-
- Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
-
- 1 2 3
- 4 5
- 6 7 8
- @end table
-
- @section extractplanes
-
- Extract color channel components from input video stream into
- separate grayscale video streams.
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item planes
- Set plane(s) to extract.
-
- Available values for planes are:
- @table @samp
- @item y
- @item u
- @item v
- @item a
- @item r
- @item g
- @item b
- @end table
-
- Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
- That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
- with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
- into 3 grayscale outputs:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section elbg
-
- Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
-
- For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
- the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
- of distinct output colors.
-
- This filter accepts the following options.
-
- @table @option
- @item codebook_length, l
- Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
- represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
-
- @item nb_steps, n
- Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
- mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
- computation time. Default value is 1.
-
- @item seed, s
- Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
- UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
- will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
-
- @item pal8
- Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
- length greater than 256.
- @end table
-
- @section fade
-
- Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item type, t
- The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
- effect.
- Default is @code{in}.
-
- @item start_frame, s
- Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
- effect at. Default is 0.
-
- @item nb_frames, n
- The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
- fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
- At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
- selected @option{color}.
- Default is 25.
-
- @item alpha
- If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
- Default value is 0.
-
- @item start_time, st
- Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
- effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
- whichever comes last. Default is 0.
-
- @item duration, d
- The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
- fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
- at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
- selected @option{color}.
- If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
- (nb_frames is used by default).
-
- @item color, c
- Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
- @example
- fade=in:0:30
- @end example
-
- The command above is equivalent to:
- @example
- fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
- @example
- fade=out:155:45
- fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
- @example
- fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
- @example
- fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
- @end example
-
- @item
- Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
- @example
- fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
- @example
- fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section fftfilt
- Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
-
- @table @option
- @item dc_Y
- Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
- accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
- value is set to @code{0}.
-
- @item dc_U
- Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
- filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
- default value is set to @code{0}.
-
- @item dc_V
- Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
- filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
- default value is set to @code{0}.
-
- @item weight_Y
- Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
-
- @item weight_U
- Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
-
- @item weight_V
- Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
-
- The filter accepts the following variables:
- @item X
- @item Y
- The coordinates of the current sample.
-
- @item W
- @item H
- The width and height of the image.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- High-pass:
- @example
- fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Low-pass:
- @example
- fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Sharpen:
- @example
- fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Blur:
- @example
- fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section field
-
- Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
- arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
- non-interlaced.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item type
- Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
- @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
- @code{bottom}).
- @end table
-
- @section fieldhint
-
- Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
- supplied as numbers by the hint file.
-
- @table @option
- @item hint
- Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
-
- There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
- numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
- Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
- is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
- for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
- field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
-
- If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
- else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
- it will be marked same as input frame.
- If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
-
- @item mode
- Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
- @end table
-
- Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
- @example
- 0,0 - # first frame
- 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
- 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
- 1,0 -
- 0,0 -
- 0,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 0,0 -
- 0,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 1,0 -
- 0,0 -
- @end example
-
- @section fieldmatch
-
- Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
- progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
- frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
- followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
-
- The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
- the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
- If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
- @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
- But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
- de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
-
- In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
- optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
- enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
- this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
- help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
- (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
- or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
-
- Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
- and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
- which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
- close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
-
- The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
- If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
- framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
- stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item order
- Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
- @item bff
- Assume bottom field first.
- @item tff
- Assume top field first.
- @end table
-
- Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
- stream.
-
- Default value is @var{auto}.
-
- @item mode
- Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
- sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
- possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
- outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
- hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
- but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
- all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
- jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
- with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
-
- More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
-
- Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item pc
- 2-way matching (p/c)
- @item pc_n
- 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
- @item pc_u
- 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
- @item pc_n_ub
- 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
- still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
- @item pcn
- 3-way matching (p/c/n)
- @item pcn_ub
- 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
- detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
- @end table
-
- The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
- mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
- @var{top}).
-
- In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
- the slowest.
-
- Default value is @var{pc_n}.
-
- @item ppsrc
- Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
- input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
- introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
- VFM/TFM.
-
- Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
-
- @item field
- Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
- @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
- certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
- large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
- @item bottom
- Match from the bottom field.
- @item top
- Match from the top field.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{auto}.
-
- @item mchroma
- Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
- cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
- only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
- artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
- the cost of some accuracy.
-
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item y0
- @item y1
- These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
- @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
- band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
- interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
- @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
- @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
- @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
- @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
-
- @item scthresh
- Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
- the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
- detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
- @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
-
- Default value is @code{12.0}.
-
- @item combmatch
- When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
- account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
- final match. Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item none
- No final matching based on combed scores.
- @item sc
- Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
- @item full
- Use combed scores all the time.
- @end table
-
- Default is @var{sc}.
-
- @item combdbg
- Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
- print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
- Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item none
- No forced calculation.
- @item pcn
- Force p/c/n calculations.
- @item pcnub
- Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{none}.
-
- @item cthresh
- This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
- essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
- Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
- can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
- @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
- be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
- range is @code{[8, 12]}.
-
- Default value is @code{9}.
-
- @item chroma
- Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
- disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
- causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
- using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
- where there is chroma only combing in the source.
-
- Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item blockx
- @item blocky
- Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
- frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
- @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
- declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
- Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
- to 512.
-
- Default value is @code{16}.
-
- @item combpel
- The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
- @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
- combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
- setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
- window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
- frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
- which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
- as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
-
- Default value is @code{80}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
- @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
-
- @subsubsection p/c/n
-
- We assume the following telecined stream:
-
- @example
- Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
- Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
- @end example
-
- The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
- first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
-
- When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
- (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
-
- @example
- Input stream:
- T 1 2 2 3 4
- B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
-
- Matches: c c n n c
-
- Output stream:
- T 1 2 3 4 4
- B 1 2 3 4 4
- @end example
-
- As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
- To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
- after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
-
- The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
- looks like this:
-
- @example
- Input stream:
- T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
- B 1 2 3 4 4
-
- Matches: c c p p c
-
- Output stream:
- T 1 2 2 3 4
- B 1 2 2 3 4
- @end example
-
- In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
- basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
-
- @itemize
- @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
- @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
- @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
- @end itemize
-
- @subsubsection u/b
-
- The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
- from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
- currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
- 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
-
- With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
- @example
- Match: c p n b u
-
- x x x x x
- Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
- Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
- x x x x x
-
- Output frames:
- 2 1 2 2 2
- 2 2 2 1 3
- @end example
-
- With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
- @example
- Match: c p n b u
-
- x x x x x
- Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
- Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
- x x x x x
-
- Output frames:
- 2 2 2 1 2
- 2 1 3 2 2
- @end example
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
- @example
- fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
- @end example
-
- Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
- @example
- fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
- @end example
-
- @section fieldorder
-
- Transform the field order of the input video.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item order
- The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
- for bottom field first.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @samp{tff}.
-
- The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
- by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
- This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
-
- If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
- flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
- not alter the incoming video.
-
- It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
- which is bottom field first.
-
- For example:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
- @end example
-
- @section fifo, afifo
-
- Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
-
- It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
- framework.
-
- It does not take parameters.
-
- @section find_rect
-
- Find a rectangular object
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item object
- Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
-
- @item threshold
- Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
-
- @item mipmaps
- Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
-
- @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
- Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section cover_rect
-
- Cover a rectangular object
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item cover
- Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
-
- @item mode
- Set covering mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item cover
- cover it by the supplied image
- @item blur
- cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{blur}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{format}
- @section format
-
- Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
- Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
- the next filter.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item pix_fmts
- A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
- "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
- @example
- format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
- @end example
-
- Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
- @example
- format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{fps}
- @section fps
-
- Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
- frames as necessary.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item fps
- The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
-
- @item round
- Rounding method.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @option
- @item zero
- zero round towards 0
- @item inf
- round away from 0
- @item down
- round towards -infinity
- @item up
- round towards +infinity
- @item near
- round to nearest
- @end table
- The default is @code{near}.
-
- @item start_time
- Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
- padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
- about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
- For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
- the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
- frames with a negative PTS.
-
- @end table
-
- Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
- @var{fps}[:@var{round}].
-
- See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
- @example
- fps=fps=25
- @end example
-
- @item
- Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
- @example
- fps=fps=film:round=near
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section framepack
-
- Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
- metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
- framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
- that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
- @ref{fps} filters.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item format
- The desired packing format. Supported values are:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item sbs
- The views are next to each other (default).
-
- @item tab
- The views are on top of each other.
-
- @item lines
- The views are packed by line.
-
- @item columns
- The views are packed by column.
-
- @item frameseq
- The views are temporally interleaved.
-
- @end table
-
- @end table
-
- Some examples:
-
- @example
- # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
- ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
-
- # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
- ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- @section framerate
-
- Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
- frames.
-
- This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
- you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
- to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item fps
- Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
- as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
-
- @item interp_start
- Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
- linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
- the default is @code{15}.
-
- @item interp_end
- Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
- linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
- the default is @code{240}.
-
- @item scene
- Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
- 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
- probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
- value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
- The default is @code{7}.
-
- @item flags
- Specify flags influencing the filter process.
-
- Available value for @var{flags} is:
-
- @table @option
- @item scene_change_detect, scd
- Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
- This flag is enabled by default.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section framestep
-
- Select one frame every N-th frame.
-
- This filter accepts the following option:
- @table @option
- @item step
- Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
- Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{frei0r}
- @section frei0r
-
- Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
-
- To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
- header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item filter_name
- The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
- @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
- directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREIOR_PATH}.
- Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
- @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
- @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
-
- @item filter_params
- A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
-
- @end table
-
- A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
- "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
- @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
- numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or by a color description specified in the "Color"
- section in the ffmpeg-utils manual), a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
- @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
-
- The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
- effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
- @example
- frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
- @example
- frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
- frei0r=colordistance:violet
- frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
- positions:
- @example
- frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- For more information, see
- @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
-
- @section fspp
-
- Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
-
- It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
- processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
- This allows for much higher speed.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item quality
- Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
- an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
-
- @item qp
- Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
- If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
-
- @item strength
- Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
- more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
- but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
-
- @item use_bframe_qp
- Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
- option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
- @code{0} (not enabled).
-
- @end table
-
- @section geq
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item lum_expr, lum
- Set the luminance expression.
- @item cb_expr, cb
- Set the chrominance blue expression.
- @item cr_expr, cr
- Set the chrominance red expression.
- @item alpha_expr, a
- Set the alpha expression.
- @item red_expr, r
- Set the red expression.
- @item green_expr, g
- Set the green expression.
- @item blue_expr, b
- Set the blue expression.
- @end table
-
- The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
- of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
- options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
- colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
- @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
- colorspace.
-
- If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
- one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
- If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
- to the luminance expression.
-
- The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
-
- @table @option
- @item N
- The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
-
- @item X
- @item Y
- The coordinates of the current sample.
-
- @item W
- @item H
- The width and height of the image.
-
- @item SW
- @item SH
- Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
- ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
- plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
- @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
-
- @item T
- Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
-
- @item p(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
- plane.
-
- @item lum(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
- plane.
-
- @item cb(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
- blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
-
- @item cr(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
- red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
-
- @item r(x, y)
- @item g(x, y)
- @item b(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
- red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
-
- @item alpha(x, y)
- Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
- plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
- @end table
-
- For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
- automatically clipped to the closer edge.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Flip the image horizontally:
- @example
- geq=p(W-X\,Y)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
- wavelength of 100 pixels:
- @example
- geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
- @example
- nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a quick emboss effect:
- @example
- format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
- @example
- geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
- the @ref{vignette} filter):
- @example
- geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section gradfun
-
- Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
- regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
- Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
- dither them.
-
- It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
- lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
- bring back the bands.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item strength
- The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
- the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
- .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
- valid range.
-
- @item radius
- The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
- gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
- regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
- values will be clipped to the valid range.
-
- @end table
-
- Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
- @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
- @example
- gradfun=3.5:8
- @end example
-
- @item
- Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
- value):
- @example
- gradfun=radius=8
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{haldclut}
- @section haldclut
-
- Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
-
- First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
- The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item shortest
- Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
- @item repeatlast
- Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
- @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
- Default is @code{1}.
- @end table
-
- @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
- filters share the same internals).
-
- More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
- (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
-
- @subsection Workflow examples
-
- @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
-
- Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
- @end example
-
- Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
-
- Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
- @end example
-
- The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
- @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
- to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
-
- @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
-
- A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
- @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
- biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
- padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
- a preview of the Hald CLUT.
-
- Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
- @code{haldclut} filter:
-
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
- pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
- smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
- [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
- [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
- @end example
-
- It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
- bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
- the color changes.
-
- Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
- @example
- ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
- @end example
-
- @section hdcd
-
- Decodes high definition audio cd data. 16-Bit PCM stream containing hdcd flags
- is converted to 20-bit PCM stream.
-
- @section hflip
-
- Flip the input video horizontally.
-
- For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
- @end example
-
- @section histeq
- This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
- per-frame basis.
-
- It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
- intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
- equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
- viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
- useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
- video.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item strength
- Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
- is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
- approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
- in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
-
- @item intensity
- Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
- values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
- the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
- must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
-
- @item antibanding
- Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
- the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
- the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
- @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
- @end table
-
- @section histogram
-
- Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
-
- The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
- distribution in an image.
-
- Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
- Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
- the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
- current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item level_height
- Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
- Allowed range is [50, 2048].
-
- @item scale_height
- Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
- Allowed range is [0, 40].
-
- @item display_mode
- Set display mode.
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item parade
- Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
-
- @item overlay
- Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
- that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
- over one another.
- @end table
- Default is @code{parade}.
-
- @item levels_mode
- Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
- Default is @code{linear}.
-
- @item components
- Set what color components to display.
- Default is @code{7}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- Calculate and draw histogram:
- @example
- ffplay -i input -vf histogram
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{hqdn3d}
- @section hqdn3d
-
- This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
- image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
- still. It should enhance compressibility.
-
- It accepts the following optional parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_spatial
- A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
- It defaults to 4.0.
-
- @item chroma_spatial
- A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
- It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
-
- @item luma_tmp
- A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
- 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
-
- @item chroma_tmp
- A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
- @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
- @section hwupload_cuda
-
- Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
-
- It accepts the following optional parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item device
- The number of the CUDA device to use
- @end table
-
- @section hqx
-
- Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
- was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
-
- It accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
- @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
- Default is @code{3}.
- @end table
-
- @section hstack
- Stack input videos horizontally.
-
- All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
-
- Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
- to create same output.
-
- The filter accept the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item inputs
- Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
-
- @item shortest
- If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
- terminates. Default value is 0.
- @end table
-
- @section hue
-
- Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item h
- Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
- and defaults to "0".
-
- @item s
- Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
- defaults to "1".
-
- @item H
- Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
- expression, and defaults to "0".
-
- @item b
- Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
- defaults to "0".
- @end table
-
- @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
- specified at the same time.
-
- The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
- expressions containing the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- frame count of the input frame starting from 0
-
- @item pts
- presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
-
- @item r
- frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
-
- @item t
- timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
-
- @item tb
- time base of the input video
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
- @example
- hue=h=90:s=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
- @example
- hue=H=PI/2:s=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
- and 2 over a period of 1 second:
- @example
- hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
- @example
- hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
- @end example
-
- The general fade-in expression can be written as:
- @example
- hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
- @example
- hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
- @end example
-
- The general fade-out expression can be written as:
- @example
- hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item b
- @item s
- @item h
- @item H
- Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @end table
-
- @section idet
-
- Detect video interlacing type.
-
- This filter tries to detect if the input frames as interlaced, progressive,
- top or bottom field first. It will also try and detect fields that are
- repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
-
- Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
- Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
-
- The filter will log these metadata values:
-
- @table @option
- @item single.current_frame
- Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
- ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
- ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
-
- @item single.tff
- Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
-
- @item multiple.tff
- Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
-
- @item single.bff
- Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
-
- @item multiple.current_frame
- Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
- ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
- ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
-
- @item multiple.bff
- Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
-
- @item single.progressive
- Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
-
- @item multiple.progressive
- Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
-
- @item single.undetermined
- Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
-
- @item multiple.undetermined
- Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
-
- @item repeated.current_frame
- Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
-
- @item repeated.neither
- Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
-
- @item repeated.top
- Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
-
- @item repeated.bottom
- Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
- @end table
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item intl_thres
- Set interlacing threshold.
- @item prog_thres
- Set progressive threshold.
- @item rep_thres
- Threshold for repeated field detection.
- @item half_life
- Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
- statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to it's
- classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
- full weight of 1.0 forever.
- @item analyze_interlaced_flag
- When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
- if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
- If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
- computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
- further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
- method to clean up the interlaced flag
- @end table
-
- @section il
-
- Deinterleave or interleave fields.
-
- This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
- deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
- fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
- half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
- You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_mode, l
- @item chroma_mode, c
- @item alpha_mode, a
- Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
- @var{alpha_mode} are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item none
- Do nothing.
-
- @item deinterleave, d
- Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
-
- @item interleave, i
- Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
- @end table
- Default value is @code{none}.
-
- @item luma_swap, ls
- @item chroma_swap, cs
- @item alpha_swap, as
- Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
- @end table
-
- @section inflate
-
- Apply inflate effect to the video.
-
- This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
- only values higher than the pixel.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item threshold0
- @item threshold1
- @item threshold2
- @item threshold3
- Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
- If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
- @end table
-
- @section interlace
-
- Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
- lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
- halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
-
- @example
- Original Original New Frame
- Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
- ========== =========== ==================
- Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
- Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
- Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
- Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
- ... ... ...
- New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
- @end example
-
- It accepts the following optional parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item scan
- This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
- (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
-
- @item lowpass
- Enable (default) or disable the vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter
- interlacing and reduce moire patterns.
- @end table
-
- @section kerndeint
-
- Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
- deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
- progressive frames.
-
- The description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item thresh
- Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
- determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
- in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
- applying the process on every pixels.
-
- @item map
- Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
- Default is 0.
-
- @item order
- Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
- 0. Default is 0.
-
- @item sharp
- Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
-
- @item twoway
- Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply default values:
- @example
- kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Enable additional sharpening:
- @example
- kerndeint=sharp=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Paint processed pixels in white:
- @example
- kerndeint=map=1
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section lenscorrection
-
- Correct radial lens distortion
-
- This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
- of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
- one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
- To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
- and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
-
- Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
- Digikam from the KDE project.
-
- In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
- this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
- brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
- cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
- be applied before or after lens correction.
-
- @subsection Options
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item cx
- Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
- distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
- width.
- @item cy
- Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
- distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
- height.
- @item k1
- Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
- @item k2
- Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. 0.5 means no correction.
- @end table
-
- The formula that generates the correction is:
-
- @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
-
- where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
- distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
-
- @section loop, aloop
-
- Loop video frames or audio samples.
-
- Those filters accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item loop
- Set the number of loops.
-
- @item size
- Set maximal size in number of frames for @code{loop} filter or maximal number
- of samples in case of @code{aloop} filter.
-
- @item start
- Set first frame of loop for @code{loop} filter or first sample of loop in case
- of @code{aloop} filter.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{lut3d}
- @section lut3d
-
- Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item file
- Set the 3D LUT file name.
-
- Currently supported formats:
- @table @samp
- @item 3dl
- AfterEffects
- @item cube
- Iridas
- @item dat
- DaVinci
- @item m3d
- Pandora
- @end table
- @item interp
- Select interpolation mode.
-
- Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item nearest
- Use values from the nearest defined point.
- @item trilinear
- Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
- @item tetrahedral
- Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
-
- Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
- to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
-
- @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
- to an RGB input video.
-
- These filters accept the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item c0
- set first pixel component expression
- @item c1
- set second pixel component expression
- @item c2
- set third pixel component expression
- @item c3
- set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
-
- @item r
- set red component expression
- @item g
- set green component expression
- @item b
- set blue component expression
- @item a
- alpha component expression
-
- @item y
- set Y/luminance component expression
- @item u
- set U/Cb component expression
- @item v
- set V/Cr component expression
- @end table
-
- Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
- the corresponding pixel component values.
-
- The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
- format in input.
-
- The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
- @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
-
- The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
-
- @table @option
- @item w
- @item h
- The input width and height.
-
- @item val
- The input value for the pixel component.
-
- @item clipval
- The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
-
- @item maxval
- The maximum value for the pixel component.
-
- @item minval
- The minimum value for the pixel component.
-
- @item negval
- The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
- @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
- "maxval-clipval+minval".
-
- @item clip(val)
- The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
- @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
-
- @item gammaval(gamma)
- The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
- clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
- expression
- "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
-
- @end table
-
- All expressions default to "val".
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Negate input video:
- @example
- lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
- lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
- @end example
-
- The above is the same as:
- @example
- lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
- lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Negate luminance:
- @example
- lutyuv=y=negval
- @end example
-
- @item
- Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
- @example
- lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply a luma burning effect:
- @example
- lutyuv="y=2*val"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Remove green and blue components:
- @example
- lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
- @example
- format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
- @example
- lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Discard least significant bits of luma:
- @example
- lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section maskedmerge
-
- Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
- weights in the third input stream.
-
- A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
- from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
- 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
- unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
- input stream's pixel components.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
- @table @option
- @item planes
- Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
- copied from first stream.
- By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
- @end table
-
- @section mcdeint
-
- Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
-
- It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
- with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
- @table @option
- @item mode
- Set the deinterlacing mode.
-
- It accepts one of the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item fast
- @item medium
- @item slow
- use iterative motion estimation
- @item extra_slow
- like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{fast}.
-
- @item parity
- Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
- one of the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item 0, tff
- assume top field first
- @item 1, bff
- assume bottom field first
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{bff}.
-
- @item qp
- Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
- encoder.
-
- Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
- optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
- @end table
-
- @section mergeplanes
-
- Merge color channel components from several video streams.
-
- The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
- planes to the output video.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
- @table @option
- @item mapping
- Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
-
- The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
- hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
- mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
- the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
- corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
- similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
- plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
- 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
-
- @item format
- Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
- @example
- [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
- @end example
-
- @item
- Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
- @example
- [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
- @end example
-
- @item
- Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
- @example
- format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
- @end example
-
- @item
- Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
- @example
- format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
- @end example
-
- @item
- Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
- @example
- format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section metadata, ametadata
-
- Manipulate frame metadata.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode
- Set mode of operation of the filter.
-
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item select
- If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
- which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
- every frame that has such key in metadata.
-
- @item add
- Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
- do nothing.
-
- @item modify
- Modify value of already present key.
-
- @item delete
- If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
- Otherwise, delete key.
-
- @item print
- Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
- metadata values available in frame.
- @end table
-
- @item key
- Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print}.
-
- @item value
- Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
- @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
-
- @item function
- Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
-
- Can be one of following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item same_str
- Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
-
- @item starts_with
- Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
- the @code{value} option string.
-
- @item less
- Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
-
- @item equal
- Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
-
- @item greater
- Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
-
- @item expr
- Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
- evaluates to true.
- @end table
-
- @item expr
- Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
- The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
- constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item VALUE1
- Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
-
- @item VALUE2
- Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
- @end table
-
- @item file
- If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. When
- filename equals "-" data is written to standard output.
- If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log with AV_LOG_INFO
- loglevel.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.singnalstats.YDIF} with values
- between 0 and 1.
- @example
- @end example
- signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
- @end itemize
-
- @section mpdecimate
-
- Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
- order to reduce frame rate.
-
- The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
- (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
- fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item max
- Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
- positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
- negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped unregarding the
- number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
-
- Default value is 0.
-
- @item hi
- @item lo
- @item frac
- Set the dropping threshold values.
-
- Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
- represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
- corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
- out differently over the block.
-
- A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
- than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
- meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
-
- Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
- 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
- @end table
-
-
- @section negate
-
- Negate input video.
-
- It accepts an integer in input; if non-zero it negates the
- alpha component (if available). The default value in input is 0.
-
- @section nnedi
-
- Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item weights
- Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
- Currently file can be found here:
- https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
-
- @item deint
- Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
- Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
-
- @item field
- Set mode of operation.
-
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item af
- Use frame flags, both fields.
- @item a
- Use frame flags, single field.
- @item t
- Use top field only.
- @item b
- Use bottom field only.
- @item tf
- Use both fields, top first.
- @item bf
- Use both fields, bottom first.
- @end table
-
- @item planes
- Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
-
- @item nsize
- Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
- network.
-
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item s8x6
- @item s16x6
- @item s32x6
- @item s48x6
- @item s8x4
- @item s16x4
- @item s32x4
- @end table
-
- @item nns
- Set the number of neurons in predicctor neural network.
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item n16
- @item n32
- @item n64
- @item n128
- @item n256
- @end table
-
- @item qual
- Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
- together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
- @code{slow}.
-
- @item etype
- Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item a
- weights trained to minimize absolute error
- @item s
- weights trained to minimize squared error
- @end table
-
- @item pscrn
- Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
- which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
- can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
- The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
- sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
- The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
- the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
- using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
- The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
- using it is almost always unnoticeable.
-
- Can be one of the following:
-
- @table @samp
- @item none
- @item original
- @item new
- @end table
-
- Default is @code{new}.
-
- @item fapprox
- Set various debugging flags.
- @end table
-
- @section noformat
-
- Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
- input to the next filter.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
-
- @item pix_fmts
- A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
- apix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
- input to the vflip filter:
- @example
- noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
- @end example
-
- @item
- Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
- @example
- noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section noise
-
- Add noise on video input frame.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item all_seed
- @item c0_seed
- @item c1_seed
- @item c2_seed
- @item c3_seed
- Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
- of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
-
- @item all_strength, alls
- @item c0_strength, c0s
- @item c1_strength, c1s
- @item c2_strength, c2s
- @item c3_strength, c3s
- Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
- @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
-
- @item all_flags, allf
- @item c0_flags, c0f
- @item c1_flags, c1f
- @item c2_flags, c2f
- @item c3_flags, c3f
- Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
- Available values for component flags are:
- @table @samp
- @item a
- averaged temporal noise (smoother)
- @item p
- mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
- @item t
- temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
- @item u
- uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
- @example
- noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
- @end example
-
- @section null
-
- Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
-
- @section ocr
- Optical Character Recognition
-
- This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item datapath
- Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
- set at installation.
-
- @item language
- Set language, default is "eng".
-
- @item whitelist
- Set character whitelist.
-
- @item blacklist
- Set character blacklist.
- @end table
-
- The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
-
- @section ocv
-
- Apply a video transform using libopencv.
-
- To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
- configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item filter_name
- The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
-
- @item filter_params
- The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
- values are assumed.
-
- @end table
-
- Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
- information:
- @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
-
- Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
-
- @anchor{dilate}
- @subsection dilate
-
- Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
- It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
-
- It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
-
- @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
- @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
-
- @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
- the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
- point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
- must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
-
- If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
- string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
- @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
- printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
- @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
- or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
-
- The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
-
- @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
- applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
-
- Some examples:
- @example
- # Use the default values
- ocv=dilate
-
- # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
- ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
-
- # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
- # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
- # *
- # ***
- # *****
- # ***
- # *
- # The specified columns and rows are ignored
- # but the anchor point coordinates are not
- ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
- @end example
-
- @subsection erode
-
- Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
- It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
-
- It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
- with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
-
- @subsection smooth
-
- Smooth the input video.
-
- The filter takes the following parameters:
- @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
-
- @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
- the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
- or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
-
- The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
- depend on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
- @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
- @var{param4} accept floating point values.
-
- The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
- other parameters is 0.
-
- These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
- libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
-
- @anchor{overlay}
- @section overlay
-
- Overlay one video on top of another.
-
- It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
- video on which the second input is overlaid.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- A description of the accepted options follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item x
- @item y
- Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
- on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
- the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
- overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
-
- @item eof_action
- The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
- one of the following values:
-
- @table @option
- @item repeat
- Repeat the last frame (the default).
- @item endall
- End both streams.
- @item pass
- Pass the main input through.
- @end table
-
- @item eval
- Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item init
- only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
- when a command is processed
-
- @item frame
- evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{frame}.
-
- @item shortest
- If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
- terminates. Default value is 0.
-
- @item format
- Set the format for the output video.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item yuv420
- force YUV420 output
-
- @item yuv422
- force YUV422 output
-
- @item yuv444
- force YUV444 output
-
- @item rgb
- force RGB output
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
-
- @item rgb @emph{(deprecated)}
- If set to 1, force the filter to accept inputs in the RGB
- color space. Default value is 0. This option is deprecated, use
- @option{format} instead.
-
- @item repeatlast
- If set to 1, force the filter to draw the last overlay frame over the
- main input until the end of the stream. A value of 0 disables this
- behavior. Default value is 1.
- @end table
-
- The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
- parameters.
-
- @table @option
- @item main_w, W
- @item main_h, H
- The main input width and height.
-
- @item overlay_w, w
- @item overlay_h, h
- The overlay input width and height.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
- each new frame.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
- format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
- @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item n
- the number of input frame, starting from 0
-
- @item pos
- the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
-
- @item t
- The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
-
- @end table
-
- Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
- when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
- when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
-
- Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
- order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
- to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
- have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
- the @var{movie} filter does.
-
- You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
- efficiency of such approach.
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item x
- @item y
- Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
- video:
- @example
- overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
- @end example
-
- Using named options the example above becomes:
- @example
- overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
- @end example
-
- @item
- Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
- using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
- @end example
-
- @item
- Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
- right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
- @end example
-
- @item
- Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
- must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
- @example
- color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
- @end example
-
- @item
- Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
- filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
- @example
- ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
- @end example
-
- The above command is the same as:
- @example
- ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
- screen starting since time 2:
- @example
- overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
- nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
- [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
- [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
- [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
- [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
- "
- @end example
-
- @item
- Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
- @example
- ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
- -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
- masked.avi
- @end example
-
- @item
- Chain several overlays in cascade:
- @example
- nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
- testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
- [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
- [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
- [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
- [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section owdenoise
-
- Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item depth
- Set depth.
-
- Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
- slow down filtering.
-
- Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
-
- @item luma_strength, ls
- Set luma strength.
-
- Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
-
- @item chroma_strength, cs
- Set chroma strength.
-
- Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{pad}
- @section pad
-
- Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
- provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
- paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
- corresponding input size is used for the output.
-
- The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
- @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
-
- The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
- with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
-
- The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
- expression, and vice versa.
-
- The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
-
- @item color
- Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
- check the "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- The default value of @var{color} is "black".
- @end table
-
- The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
- options are expressions containing the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item in_w
- @item in_h
- The input video width and height.
-
- @item iw
- @item ih
- These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
-
- @item out_w
- @item out_h
- The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
- specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
-
- @item ow
- @item oh
- These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
- expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
-
- @item a
- same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
-
- @item sar
- input sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
- size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
- column 0, row 40
- @example
- pad=640:480:0:40:violet
- @end example
-
- The example above is equivalent to the following command:
- @example
- pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
- @end example
-
- @item
- Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
- and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
- @example
- pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
- value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
- the center of the padded area:
- @example
- pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
- @example
- pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
- correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
- according to the relation:
- @example
- (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
- X = output_dar / sar
- @end example
-
- Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
- @example
- pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
- corner of the output padded area:
- @example
- pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{palettegen}
- @section palettegen
-
- Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item max_colors
- Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
- Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
- will be black.
-
- @item reserve_transparent
- Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
- transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
- If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
- to disable this option for a standalone image.
- Set by default.
-
- @item stats_mode
- Set statistics mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item full
- Compute full frame histograms.
- @item diff
- Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
- might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
- the background is static.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{full}.
- @end table
-
- The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
- (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
- color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
- @var{info} logging level.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section paletteuse
-
- Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
-
- The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
- be a 256 pixels image.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item dither
- Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
- @table @samp
- @item bayer
- Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
- @item heckbert
- Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
- Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
- reference.
- @item floyd_steinberg
- Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
- @item sierra2
- Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
- @item sierra2_4a
- Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
- @end table
-
- Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
-
- @item bayer_scale
- When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
- pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
- visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
- at the cost of more banding.
-
- The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
-
- @item diff_mode
- If set, define the zone to process
-
- @table @samp
- @item rectangle
- Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
- cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
- if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
- scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
- moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
- much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
- @end table
-
- Default is @var{none}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
- using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section perspective
-
- Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
-
- A description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item x0
- @item y0
- @item x1
- @item y1
- @item x2
- @item y2
- @item x3
- @item y3
- Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
- Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
- If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
- to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
- then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
-
- The expressions can use the following variables:
-
- @table @option
- @item W
- @item H
- the width and height of video frame.
- @item in
- Input frame count.
- @item on
- Output frame count.
- @end table
-
- @item interpolation
- Set interpolation for perspective correction.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item linear
- @item cubic
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{linear}.
-
- @item sense
- Set interpretation of coordinate options.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item 0, source
-
- Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
- the corners of the destination.
-
- @item 1, destination
-
- Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
- by the given coordinates.
-
- Default value is @samp{source}.
- @end table
-
- @item eval
- Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item init
- only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
- when a command is processed
-
- @item frame
- evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{init}.
- @end table
-
- @section phase
-
- Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
-
- The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
- opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
-
- A description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item mode
- Set phase mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item t
- Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
- Filter will delay the bottom field.
-
- @item b
- Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
- Filter will delay the top field.
-
- @item p
- Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
- for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
- actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
-
- @item a
- Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
- opposite.
- Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
- basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
- then this works just like @samp{u}.
-
- @item u
- Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
- Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
- analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
- match between the fields.
-
- @item T
- Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
- Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
-
- @item B
- Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
- Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
-
- @item A
- Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
- Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
- image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
- like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
-
- @item U
- Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
- Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section pixdesctest
-
- Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
- testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
-
- For example:
- @example
- format=monow, pixdesctest
- @end example
-
- can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
-
- @section pp
-
- Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
- library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
- Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
- Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
- interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
-
- The filters accept the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item subfilters
- Set postprocessing subfilters string.
- @end table
-
- All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
-
- @table @option
- @item a/autoq
- Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
-
- @item c/chrom
- Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
-
- @item y/nochrom
- Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
-
- @item n/noluma
- Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
- @end table
-
- These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
-
- Available subfilters are:
-
- @table @option
- @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
- Horizontal deblocking filter
- @table @option
- @item difference
- Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
- @item flatness
- Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
- @end table
-
- @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
- Vertical deblocking filter
- @table @option
- @item difference
- Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
- @item flatness
- Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
- @end table
-
- @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
- Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
- @table @option
- @item difference
- Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
- @item flatness
- Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
- @end table
-
- @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
- Accurate vertical deblocking filter
- @table @option
- @item difference
- Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
- @item flatness
- Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
- @end table
- @end table
-
- The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
- flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
- thresholds.
-
- @table @option
- @item h1/x1hdeblock
- Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
-
- @item v1/x1vdeblock
- Experimental vertical deblocking filter
-
- @item dr/dering
- Deringing filter
-
- @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
- @table @option
- @item threshold1
- larger -> stronger filtering
- @item threshold2
- larger -> stronger filtering
- @item threshold3
- larger -> stronger filtering
- @end table
-
- @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
- @table @option
- @item f/fullyrange
- Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
- @end table
-
- @item lb/linblenddeint
- Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
- filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
-
- @item li/linipoldeint
- Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
- linearly interpolating every second line.
-
- @item ci/cubicipoldeint
- Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
- cubically interpolating every second line.
-
- @item md/mediandeint
- Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
- median filter to every second line.
-
- @item fd/ffmpegdeint
- FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
- second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
-
- @item l5/lowpass5
- Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
- block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
-
- @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
- Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
- specify.
- @table @option
- @item quantizer
- Quantizer to use
- @end table
-
- @item de/default
- Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
-
- @item fa/fast
- Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
-
- @item ac
- High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
- brightness/contrast:
- @example
- pp=hb/vb/dr/al
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
- @example
- pp=de/-al
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
- @example
- pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
- automatically depending on available CPU time:
- @example
- pp=hb|y/vb|a
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section pp7
- Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
- similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
- used after IDCT.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item qp
- Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
- 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
- (if available).
-
- @item mode
- Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item hard
- Set hard thresholding.
- @item soft
- Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
- @item medium
- Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section psnr
-
- Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
- Ratio) between two input videos.
-
- This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
- considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
- output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
- the PSNR.
-
- Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
- this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
- have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
-
- The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
-
- The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
- frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
- equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
-
- @example
- PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
- @end example
-
- Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
- image.
-
- The description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item stats_file, f
- If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
- each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
- standard output.
- @end table
-
- The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
- key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
- couple of frames.
-
- A description of each shown parameter follows:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
-
- @item mse_avg
- Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
- frames, averaged over all the image components.
-
- @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_g, mse_a
- Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
- frames for the component specified by the suffix.
-
- @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
- Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
- specified by the suffix.
- @end table
-
- For example:
- @example
- movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
- [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
- @end example
-
- On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
- reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
- is stored in @file{stats.log}.
-
- @anchor{pullup}
- @section pullup
-
- Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
- hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
- content.
-
- The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
- its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
- onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
- fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
-
- To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
- pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
- @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item jl
- @item jr
- @item jt
- @item jb
- These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
- bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
- while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
- The default is 8 pixels on each side.
-
- @item sb
- Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
- filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
- excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
- Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
- This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
- the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
- Default value is @code{0}.
-
- @item mp
- Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item l
- Use luma plane.
-
- @item u
- Use chroma blue plane.
-
- @item v
- Use chroma red plane.
- @end table
-
- This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
- for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
- source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
- is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
- The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
- load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
- @end table
-
- For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
- necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
- telecine NTSC input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
- @end example
-
- @section qp
-
- Change video quantization parameters (QP).
-
- The filter accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item qp
- Set expression for quantization parameter.
- @end table
-
- The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
- the following constants:
-
- @table @var
- @item known
- 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
-
- @item qp
- Sequentional index starting from -129 to 128.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Some equation like:
- @example
- qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section random
-
- Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
- No frame is discarded.
- Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
-
- @table @option
- @item frames
- Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
- @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
-
- @item seed
- Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
- @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
- less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
- best effort basis.
- @end table
-
- @section readvitc
-
- Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
- video frame.
-
- The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
- timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
- @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
- timecode data has been found or not.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item scan_max
- Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
- @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
-
- @item thr_b
- Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
- default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
-
- @item thr_w
- Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
- default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
- draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section remap
-
- Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
-
- Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
- where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
- value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
-
- Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
- will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
- Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
-
- @section removegrain
-
- The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
-
- @table @option
- @item m0
- Set mode for the first plane.
-
- @item m1
- Set mode for the second plane.
-
- @item m2
- Set mode for the third plane.
-
- @item m3
- Set mode for the fourth plane.
- @end table
-
- Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
-
- @table @var
- @item 0
- Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
-
- @item 1
- Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
-
- @item 2
- Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
-
- @item 3
- Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
-
- @item 4
- Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
- This is equivalent to a median filter.
-
- @item 5
- Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
-
- @item 6
- Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
-
- @item 7
- Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
-
- @item 8
- Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
-
- @item 9
- Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
-
- @item 10
- Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
-
- @item 11
- [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
-
- @item 12
- Same as mode 11.
-
- @item 13
- Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
- pixels are the closest.
-
- @item 14
- Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
- pixels are the closest.
-
- @item 15
- Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
- interpolation formula.
-
- @item 16
- Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
- interpolation formula.
-
- @item 17
- Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
- minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
-
- @item 18
- Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
- the current pixel is minimal.
-
- @item 19
- Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
-
- @item 20
- Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
-
- @item 21
- Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
-
- @item 22
- Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
-
- @item 23
- Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
-
- @item 24
- Similar as 23.
- @end table
-
- @section removelogo
-
- Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
- pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
- comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item filename, f
- Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
- libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
- video stream being processed.
- @end table
-
- Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
- considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
- the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
- rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
- recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
- visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
- filter once or twice.
-
- If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
- logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
- reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
- much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
- the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
- pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
-
- @section repeatfields
-
- This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
- fields based on its value.
-
- @section reverse, areverse
-
- Reverse a clip.
-
- Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
- is suggested.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
- @example
- trim=end=5,reverse
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section rotate
-
- Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- A description of the optional parameters follows.
- @table @option
- @item angle, a
- Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
- clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
- result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
-
- This expression is evaluated for each frame.
-
- @item out_w, ow
- Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
- This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
-
- @item out_h, oh
- Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
- This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
-
- @item bilinear
- Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
- it. Default value is 1.
-
- @item fillcolor, c
- Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
- image. For the general syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
- ffmpeg-utils manual. If the special value "none" is selected then no
- background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
-
- Default value is "black".
- @end table
-
- The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
- following constants and functions:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
- before the first frame is filtered.
-
- @item t
- time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
- configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item in_w, iw
- @item in_h, ih
- the input video width and height
-
- @item out_w, ow
- @item out_h, oh
- the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
- specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
-
- @item rotw(a)
- @item roth(a)
- the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
- video rotated by @var{a} radians.
-
- These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
- @option{out_h} expressions.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
- @example
- rotate=PI/6
- @end example
-
- @item
- Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
- @example
- rotate=-PI/6
- @end example
-
- @item
- Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
- @example
- rotate=45*PI/180
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
- @example
- rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
- seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
- @example
- rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
- input video is always completely contained in the output:
- @example
- rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
- shown:
- @example
- rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- The filter supports the following commands:
-
- @table @option
- @item a, angle
- Set the angle expression.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @end table
-
- @section sab
-
- Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_radius, lr
- Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
- value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
- in slower processing.
-
- @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
- Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
- value is 1.0.
-
- @item luma_strength, ls
- Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
- be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
-
- @item chroma_radius, cr
- Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0. A
- greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
- processing.
-
- @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
- Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range.
-
- @item chroma_strength, cs
- Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
- must be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range.
- @end table
-
- Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
- corresponding luma option value.
-
- @anchor{scale}
- @section scale
-
- Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
-
- The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
- of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
-
- If the input image format is different from the format requested by
- the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
- requested format.
-
- @subsection Options
- The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
- supported by the libswscale scaler.
-
- See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
- the complete list of scaler options.
-
- @table @option
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
- dimension.
-
- If the value is 0, the input width is used for the output.
-
- If one of the values is -1, the scale filter will use a value that
- maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
- other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
- used
-
- If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the scale filter will also use a value
- that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
- specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
- dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
-
- See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
- expression.
-
- @item eval
- Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item init
- Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
-
- @item frame
- Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
-
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{init}.
-
-
- @item interl
- Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item 1
- Force interlaced aware scaling.
-
- @item 0
- Do not apply interlaced scaling.
-
- @item -1
- Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
- are flagged as interlaced or not.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{0}.
-
- @item flags
- Set libswscale scaling flags. See
- @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
- complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
- the default flags.
-
-
- @item param0, param1
- Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
- @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
- complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
- empty parameters.
-
-
-
- @item size, s
- Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item in_color_matrix
- @item out_color_matrix
- Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
-
- This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
- a specific value used for the output and encoder.
-
- If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
-
- Possible values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- Choose automatically.
-
- @item bt709
- Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
- Recommendation BT.709.
-
- @item fcc
- Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
- Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
-
- @item bt601
- Set color space conforming to:
-
- @itemize
- @item
- ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
-
- @item
- ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
-
- @item
- Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
-
- @end itemize
-
- @item smpte240m
- Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
- @end table
-
- @item in_range
- @item out_range
- Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
-
- This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
- a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
- range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- Choose automatically.
-
- @item jpeg/full/pc
- Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
-
- @item mpeg/tv
- Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
- @end table
-
- @item force_original_aspect_ratio
- Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
- keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item disable
- Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
-
- @item decrease
- The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
-
- @item increase
- The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
-
- @end table
-
- One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
- maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
- that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
- 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
- decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
- 1280x533.
-
- Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
- or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
- to work.
-
- @end table
-
- The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
- containing the following constants:
-
- @table @var
- @item in_w
- @item in_h
- The input width and height
-
- @item iw
- @item ih
- These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
-
- @item out_w
- @item out_h
- The output (scaled) width and height
-
- @item ow
- @item oh
- These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
-
- @item a
- The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
-
- @item sar
- input sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item ohsub
- @item ovsub
- horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
- @example
- scale=w=200:h=100
- @end example
-
- This is equivalent to:
- @example
- scale=200:100
- @end example
-
- or:
- @example
- scale=200x100
- @end example
-
- @item
- Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
- @example
- scale=qcif
- @end example
-
- which can also be written as:
- @example
- scale=size=qcif
- @end example
-
- @item
- Scale the input to 2x:
- @example
- scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
- @end example
-
- @item
- The above is the same as:
- @example
- scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
- @end example
-
- @item
- Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
- @example
- scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Scale the input to half size:
- @example
- scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
- @example
- scale=3/2*iw:ow
- @end example
-
- @item
- Seek Greek harmony:
- @example
- scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
- scale=ih*PHI:ih
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
- @example
- scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
- subsample values:
- @example
- scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
- keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
- @example
- scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- This filter supports the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- Set the output video dimension expression.
- The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
-
- If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
- value.
- @end table
-
- @section scale2ref
-
- Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
-
- See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
- uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Scale a subtitle stream to match the main video in size before overlaying
- @example
- 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{selectivecolor}
- @section selectivecolor
-
- Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
- as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
- by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
-
- This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item correction_method
- Select color correction method.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item absolute
- Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
- component value).
- @item relative
- Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
- @end table
- Default is @code{absolute}.
- @item reds
- Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
- @item yellows
- Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
- @item greens
- Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
- @item cyans
- Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
- @item blues
- Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
- @item magentas
- Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
- @item whites
- Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
- @item neutrals
- Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
- @item blacks
- Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
- @item psfile
- Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
- @end table
-
- All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
- 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
- respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
- pixels of its range.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
- increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
- @example
- selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
- @example
- selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section separatefields
-
- The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
- each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
- with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
-
- This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
- of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
- If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
-
- @section setdar, setsar
-
- The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
- output video.
-
- This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
- Ratio, according to the following equation:
- @example
- @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
- @end example
-
- Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
- dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
- this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
- e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
- applied.
-
- The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
- the filter output video.
-
- Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
- output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
- above.
-
- Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
- filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
- another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
- Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
-
- The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
- a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
- @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
- the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
- In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
- should be escaped.
-
- @item max
- Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
- denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
- Default value is @code{100}.
-
- @end table
-
- The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
- the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item E, PI, PHI
- These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
- (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
-
- @item w, h
- The input width and height.
-
- @item a
- These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
-
- @item sar
- The input sample aspect ratio.
-
- @item dar
- The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
- (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
-
- @item hsub, vsub
- Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
- @example
- setdar=dar=1.77777
- setdar=dar=16/9
- @end example
-
- @item
- To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
- @example
- setsar=sar=10/11
- @end example
-
- @item
- To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
- 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
- @example
- setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{setfield}
- @section setfield
-
- Force field for the output video frame.
-
- The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
- output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
- corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
- following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item mode
- Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- Keep the same field property.
-
- @item bff
- Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
-
- @item tff
- Mark the frame as top-field-first.
-
- @item prog
- Mark the frame as progressive.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section showinfo
-
- Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
- The input video is not modified.
-
- The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
- @var{key}:@var{value}.
-
- The following values are shown in the output:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item pts
- The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
- time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
-
- @item pts_time
- The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
- seconds.
-
- @item pos
- The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
- unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
-
- @item fmt
- The pixel format name.
-
- @item sar
- The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
- @var{num}/@var{den}.
-
- @item s
- The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item i
- The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
- for bottom field first).
-
- @item iskey
- This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
-
- @item type
- The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
- P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
- Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
- the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
- @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
-
- @item checksum
- The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
-
- @item plane_checksum
- The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
- expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
- @end table
-
- @section showpalette
-
- Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
- @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
-
- It accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item s
- Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
- @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
- @end table
-
- @section shuffleframes
-
- Reorder and/or duplicate video frames.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item mapping
- Set the destination indexes of input frames.
- This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
- frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
- @end table
-
- The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
-
- Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- @section shuffleplanes
-
- Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item map0
- The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
-
- @item map1
- The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
-
- @item map2
- The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
-
- @item map3
- The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
-
- @end table
-
- The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
-
- Swap the second and third planes of the input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
- @end example
-
- @anchor{signalstats}
- @section signalstats
- Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
- with the digitization of analog video media.
-
- By default the filter will log these metadata values:
-
- @table @option
- @item YMIN
- Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item YLOW
- Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item YAVG
- Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
- [0-255].
-
- @item YHIGH
- Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item YMAX
- Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item UMIN
- Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item ULOW
- Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item UAVG
- Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
- [0-255].
-
- @item UHIGH
- Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item UMAX
- Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item VMIN
- Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item VLOW
- Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item VAVG
- Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
- [0-255].
-
- @item VHIGH
- Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item VMAX
- Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
- range of [0-255].
-
- @item SATMIN
- Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
-
- @item SATLOW
- Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
-
- @item SATAVG
- Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
- of [0-~181.02].
-
- @item SATHIGH
- Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
-
- @item SATMAX
- Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
-
- @item HUEMED
- Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
- [0-360].
-
- @item HUEAVG
- Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
- [0-360].
-
- @item YDIF
- Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
- plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-255].
-
- @item UDIF
- Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
- plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-255].
-
- @item VDIF
- Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
- plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
- Expressed in range of [0-255].
- @end table
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item stat
- @item out
-
- @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
- @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
-
- Both options accept the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item tout
- Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
- unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
- include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
-
- @item vrep
- Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
- similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
- repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
- analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
- analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
-
- @item brng
- Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
- @end table
-
- @item color, c
- Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
- yellow.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Output data of various video metrics:
- @example
- ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
- @end example
-
- @item
- Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
- @example
- ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
- @end example
-
- @item
- Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
- @example
- ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
- @example
- ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
- @end example
-
- The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
- @example
- time %@{pts:hms@}
- Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
- U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
- V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
- saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
-
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{smartblur}
- @section smartblur
-
- Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_radius, lr
- Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
- the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
- used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
-
- @item luma_strength, ls
- Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
- in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
- in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
- [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
-
- @item luma_threshold, lt
- Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
- whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
- integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
- a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
- in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
-
- @item chroma_radius, cr
- Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
- the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
- used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
-
- @item chroma_strength, cs
- Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
- in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
- in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
- [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
-
- @item chroma_threshold, ct
- Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
- whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
- integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
- a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
- in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
- @end table
-
- If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
- is set.
-
- @section ssim
-
- Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
-
- This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
- considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
- output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
- the SSIM.
-
- Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
- this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
- have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
-
- The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
-
- The description of the accepted parameters follows.
-
- @table @option
- @item stats_file, f
- If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
- each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
- standard output.
- @end table
-
- The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
- key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
- couple of frames.
-
- A description of each shown parameter follows:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
-
- @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
- SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
-
- @item All
- SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
-
- @item dB
- Same as above but in dB representation.
- @end table
-
- For example:
- @example
- movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
- [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
- @end example
-
- On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
- reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
- is stored in @file{stats.log}.
-
- Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
- @end example
-
- @section stereo3d
-
- Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
-
- The filters accept the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item in
- Set stereoscopic image format of input.
-
- Available values for input image formats are:
- @table @samp
- @item sbsl
- side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
-
- @item sbsr
- side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
-
- @item sbs2l
- side by side parallel with half width resolution
- (left eye left, right eye right)
-
- @item sbs2r
- side by side crosseye with half width resolution
- (right eye left, left eye right)
-
- @item abl
- above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
-
- @item abr
- above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
-
- @item ab2l
- above-below with half height resolution
- (left eye above, right eye below)
-
- @item ab2r
- above-below with half height resolution
- (right eye above, left eye below)
-
- @item al
- alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
-
- @item ar
- alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
-
- @item irl
- interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
-
- @item irr
- interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
-
- @item icl
- interleaved columns, left eye first
-
- @item icr
- interleaved columns, right eye first
-
- Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
- @end table
-
- @item out
- Set stereoscopic image format of output.
-
- @table @samp
- @item sbsl
- side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
-
- @item sbsr
- side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
-
- @item sbs2l
- side by side parallel with half width resolution
- (left eye left, right eye right)
-
- @item sbs2r
- side by side crosseye with half width resolution
- (right eye left, left eye right)
-
- @item abl
- above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
-
- @item abr
- above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
-
- @item ab2l
- above-below with half height resolution
- (left eye above, right eye below)
-
- @item ab2r
- above-below with half height resolution
- (right eye above, left eye below)
-
- @item al
- alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
-
- @item ar
- alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
-
- @item irl
- interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
-
- @item irr
- interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
-
- @item arbg
- anaglyph red/blue gray
- (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
-
- @item argg
- anaglyph red/green gray
- (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
-
- @item arcg
- anaglyph red/cyan gray
- (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
-
- @item arch
- anaglyph red/cyan half colored
- (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
-
- @item arcc
- anaglyph red/cyan color
- (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
-
- @item arcd
- anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
- (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
-
- @item agmg
- anaglyph green/magenta gray
- (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
-
- @item agmh
- anaglyph green/magenta half colored
- (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
-
- @item agmc
- anaglyph green/magenta colored
- (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
-
- @item agmd
- anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
- (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
-
- @item aybg
- anaglyph yellow/blue gray
- (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
-
- @item aybh
- anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
- (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
-
- @item aybc
- anaglyph yellow/blue colored
- (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
-
- @item aybd
- anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
- (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
-
- @item ml
- mono output (left eye only)
-
- @item mr
- mono output (right eye only)
-
- @item chl
- checkerboard, left eye first
-
- @item chr
- checkerboard, right eye first
-
- @item icl
- interleaved columns, left eye first
-
- @item icr
- interleaved columns, right eye first
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{arcd}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
- @example
- stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
- @end example
-
- @item
- Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
- @example
- stereo3d=abl:sbsr
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section streamselect, astreamselect
- Select video or audio streams.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item inputs
- Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
-
- @item map
- Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
- commands:
-
- @table @option
- @item map
- Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
- @example
- sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Same as above, but for audio:
- @example
- asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{spp}
- @section spp
-
- Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
- at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
- and average the results.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item quality
- Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
- an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
- effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
- that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
- @code{3}.
-
- @item qp
- Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
- from the video stream (if available).
-
- @item mode
- Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item hard
- Set hard thresholding (default).
- @item soft
- Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
- @end table
-
- @item use_bframe_qp
- Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
- option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
- @code{0} (not enabled).
- @end table
-
- @anchor{subtitles}
- @section subtitles
-
- Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
- libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
- Alpha) subtitles format.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item filename, f
- Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
-
- @item original_size
- Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
- was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
- correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
-
- @item fontsdir
- Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
- These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
-
- @item charenc
- Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
- useful if not UTF-8.
-
- @item stream_index, si
- Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
-
- @item force_style
- Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
- string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
- @end table
-
- If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
- specifies the @option{filename}.
-
- For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
- video, use the command:
- @example
- subtitles=sub.srt
- @end example
-
- which is equivalent to:
- @example
- subtitles=filename=sub.srt
- @end example
-
- To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
- @example
- subtitles=video.mkv
- @end example
-
- To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
- @example
- subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
- @end example
-
- To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in transparent green
- @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
- @example
- subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HAA00FF00'
- @end example
-
- @section super2xsai
-
- Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
- Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
-
- Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
-
- @section swaprect
-
- Swap two rectangular objects in video.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item w
- Set object width.
-
- @item h
- Set object height.
-
- @item x1
- Set 1st rect x coordinate.
-
- @item y1
- Set 1st rect y coordinate.
-
- @item x2
- Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
-
- @item y2
- Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
-
- All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
- @end table
-
- The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item w
- @item h
- The input width and height.
-
- @item a
- same as @var{w} / @var{h}
-
- @item sar
- input sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
-
- @item n
- The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item t
- The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
-
- @item pos
- the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
- @end table
-
- @section swapuv
- Swap U & V plane.
-
- @section telecine
-
- Apply telecine process to the video.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item first_field
- @table @samp
- @item top, t
- top field first
- @item bottom, b
- bottom field first
- The default value is @code{top}.
- @end table
-
- @item pattern
- A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
- The default value is @code{23}.
- @end table
-
- @example
- Some typical patterns:
-
- NTSC output (30i):
- 27.5p: 32222
- 24p: 23 (classic)
- 24p: 2332 (preferred)
- 20p: 33
- 18p: 334
- 16p: 3444
-
- PAL output (25i):
- 27.5p: 12222
- 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
- 16.67p: 33
- 16p: 33333334
- @end example
-
- @section thumbnail
- Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
- will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
- the end. Default is @code{100}.
- @end table
-
- Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
- value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Extract one picture each 50 frames:
- @example
- thumbnail=50
- @end example
-
- @item
- Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section tile
-
- Tile several successive frames together.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item layout
- Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
- this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item nb_frames
- Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
- than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
- the area will be used.
-
- @item margin
- Set the outer border margin in pixels.
-
- @item padding
- Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
- more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
- refer to the pad video filter.
-
- @item color
- Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
- "Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. The default value of @var{color}
- is "black".
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
- @example
- ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
- @end example
- The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
- duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
- rate.
-
- @item
- Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
- with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
- mixed flat and named options:
- @example
- tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section tinterlace
-
- Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
-
- Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
- considered odd.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item mode
- Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
- as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
-
- Available values are:
-
- @table @samp
- @item merge, 0
- Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
- generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- @end example
-
- @item drop_even, 1
- Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
- unchanged height at half frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 11111 33333
- 11111 33333
- 11111 33333
- 11111 33333
- @end example
-
- @item drop_odd, 2
- Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
- unchanged height at half frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 22222 44444
- 22222 44444
- 22222 44444
- 22222 44444
- @end example
-
- @item pad, 3
- Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
- generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 11111 ..... 33333 .....
- ..... 22222 ..... 44444
- 11111 ..... 33333 .....
- ..... 22222 ..... 44444
- 11111 ..... 33333 .....
- ..... 22222 ..... 44444
- 11111 ..... 33333 .....
- ..... 22222 ..... 44444
- @end example
-
-
- @item interleave_top, 4
- Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
- even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
- 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
- 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
- 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
-
- Output:
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- @end example
-
-
- @item interleave_bottom, 5
- Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
- even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
- 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
- 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
- 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
-
- Output:
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- 22222 44444
- 11111 33333
- @end example
-
-
- @item interlacex2, 6
- Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
- containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
- the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
- the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
- field synchronisation.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
- 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
- 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
- @end example
-
-
- @item mergex2, 7
- Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
- generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
-
- @example
- ------> time
- Input:
- Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
-
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
- 11111 22222 33333 44444
-
- Output:
- 11111 33333 33333 55555
- 22222 22222 44444 44444
- 11111 33333 33333 55555
- 22222 22222 44444 44444
- 11111 33333 33333 55555
- 22222 22222 44444 44444
- 11111 33333 33333 55555
- 22222 22222 44444 44444
- @end example
-
- @end table
-
- Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
- compatibility reasons.
-
- Default mode is @code{merge}.
-
- @item flags
- Specify flags influencing the filter process.
-
- Available value for @var{flags} is:
-
- @table @option
- @item low_pass_filter, vlfp
- Enable vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
- Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
- destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
- vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
- patterning.
-
- Vertical low-pass filtering can only be enabled for @option{mode}
- @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
-
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @section transpose
-
- Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item dir
- Specify the transposition direction.
-
- Can assume the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
- Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
- @example
- L.R L.l
- . . -> . .
- l.r R.r
- @end example
-
- @item 1, 5, clock
- Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
- @example
- L.R l.L
- . . -> . .
- l.r r.R
- @end example
-
- @item 2, 6, cclock
- Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
- @example
- L.R R.r
- . . -> . .
- l.r L.l
- @end example
-
- @item 3, 7, clock_flip
- Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
- @example
- L.R r.R
- . . -> . .
- l.r l.L
- @end example
- @end table
-
- For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
- video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
- deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
-
- Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
- symbolic constants.
-
- @item passthrough
- Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
- specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item none
- Always apply transposition.
- @item portrait
- Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
- @item landscape
- Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
- @end table
-
- Default value is @code{none}.
- @end table
-
- For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
- layout:
- @example
- transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
- @end example
-
- The command above can also be specified as:
- @example
- transpose=1:portrait
- @end example
-
- @section trim
- Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
- @table @option
- @item start
- Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
- timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
-
- @item end
- Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
- immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
- frame in the output.
-
- @item start_pts
- This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
- in timebase units instead of seconds.
-
- @item end_pts
- This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
- in timebase units instead of seconds.
-
- @item duration
- The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
-
- @item start_frame
- The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
-
- @item end_frame
- The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
- @end table
-
- @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
- duration specifications; see
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
-
- Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
- option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
- frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
- the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
- setpts filter after the trim filter.
-
- If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
- keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
- only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
- filters.
-
- The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
- just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
-
- Examples:
- @itemize
- @item
- Drop everything except the second minute of input:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
- @end example
-
- @item
- Keep only the first second:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
-
- @anchor{unsharp}
- @section unsharp
-
- Sharpen or blur the input video.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item luma_msize_x, lx
- Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
- 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
-
- @item luma_msize_y, ly
- Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
- and 63. The default value is 5.
-
- @item luma_amount, la
- Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
- values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
-
- Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
- sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
-
- Default value is 1.0.
-
- @item chroma_msize_x, cx
- Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
- between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
-
- @item chroma_msize_y, cy
- Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
- between 3 and 63. The default value is 5.
-
- @item chroma_amount, ca
- Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
- values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
-
- Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
- sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
-
- Default value is 0.0.
-
- @item opencl
- If set to 1, specify using OpenCL capabilities, only available if
- FFmpeg was configured with @code{--enable-opencl}. Default value is 0.
-
- @end table
-
- All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
- string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
- @example
- unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
- @example
- unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section uspp
-
- Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
- the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
- shifts and average the results.
-
- The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
- decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
- DCT similar to MJPEG.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item quality
- Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
- an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
- effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
- that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
- @code{3}.
-
- @item qp
- Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
- from the video stream (if available).
- @end table
-
- @section vectorscope
-
- Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
- a vectorscope).
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode, m
- Set vectorscope mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item gray
- Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
- same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
-
- @item color
- Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
- present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
- set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
-
- @item color2
- Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
-
- @item color3
- Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
- on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
- default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
-
- @item color4
- Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
- colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
- not present in graph is picked.
-
- @item color5
- Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
- component picked from radial gradient.
- @end table
-
- @item x
- Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
-
- @item y
- Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
-
- @item intensity, i
- Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
- of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
-
- @item envelope, e
- @table @samp
- @item none
- No envelope, this is default.
-
- @item instant
- Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
-
- @item peak
- Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
- can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
-
- @item peak+instant
- Peak and instant envelope combined together.
- @end table
-
- @item graticule, g
- Set what kind of graticule to draw.
- @table @samp
- @item none
- @item green
- @item color
- @end table
-
- @item opacity, o
- Set graticule opacity.
-
- @item flags, f
- Set graticule flags.
-
- @table @samp
- @item white
- Draw graticule for white point.
-
- @item black
- Draw graticule for black point.
-
- @item name
- Draw color points short names.
- @end table
-
- @item bgopacity, b
- Set background opacity.
-
- @item lthreshold, l
- Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
- Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
- Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
- can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
- is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
-
- @item hthreshold, h
- Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
- Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
- Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
- can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
- is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
-
- @item colorspace, c
- Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
- @table @samp
- @item auto
- @item 601
- @item 709
- @end table
- Default is auto.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{vidstabdetect}
- @section vidstabdetect
-
- Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
- @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
-
- This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
- transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
- the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item result
- Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
- Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
-
- @item shakiness
- Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
- integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
- value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
-
- @item accuracy
- Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
- range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
- accuracy. Default value is 15.
-
- @item stepsize
- Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
- scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
-
- @item mincontrast
- Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
- discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
- value is 0.3.
-
- @item tripod
- Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
-
- If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
- in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
- is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
- the camera view absolutely still.
-
- If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
-
- @item show
- Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
- integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
- visualization.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Use default values:
- @example
- vidstabdetect
- @end example
-
- @item
- Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
- @file{mytransforms.trf}:
- @example
- vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
- video:
- @example
- vidstabdetect=show=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{vidstabtransform}
- @section vidstabtransform
-
- Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
- see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
-
- Read a file with transform information for each frame and
- apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
- filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
- @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
- the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
- @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
-
- @subsection Options
-
- @table @option
- @item input
- Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
- @file{transforms.trf}.
-
- @item smoothing
- Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
- camera movements. Default value is 10.
-
- For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
- past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
- larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
- the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
- camera is simulated.
-
- @item optalgo
- Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
-
- Accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item gauss
- gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
- @item avg
- averaging on transformations
- @end table
-
- @item maxshift
- Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
- meaning no limit.
-
- @item maxangle
- Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
- value is -1, meaning no limit.
-
- @item crop
- Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
- compensation.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item keep
- keep image information from previous frame (default)
- @item black
- fill the border black
- @end table
-
- @item invert
- Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
-
- @item relative
- Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
- absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
-
- @item zoom
- Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
- effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
- zoom).
-
- @item optzoom
- Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
-
- Accepted values are:
- @table @samp
- @item 0
- disabled
- @item 1
- optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
- will lead to visible borders) (default)
- @item 2
- optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
- visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
- @end table
-
- Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
-
- @item zoomspeed
- Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
- @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
- 0.25.
-
- @item interpol
- Specify type of interpolation.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item no
- no interpolation
- @item linear
- linear only horizontal
- @item bilinear
- linear in both directions (default)
- @item bicubic
- cubic in both directions (slow)
- @end table
-
- @item tripod
- Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
- @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
-
- Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
-
- @item debug
- Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
- are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
- value is 0.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
- @end example
-
- Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
-
- @item
- Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
- @example
- vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Smoothen the video even more:
- @example
- vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section vflip
-
- Flip the input video vertically.
-
- For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
- @end example
-
- @anchor{vignette}
- @section vignette
-
- Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item angle, a
- Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
-
- The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
-
- Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
-
- @item x0
- @item y0
- Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
- by default.
-
- @item mode
- Set forward/backward mode.
-
- Available modes are:
- @table @samp
- @item forward
- The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
-
- @item backward
- The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
- This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
- detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
- also be used to create a burning effect.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{forward}.
-
- @item eval
- Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item init
- Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
-
- @item frame
- Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
- @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
- allows advanced dynamic expressions.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{init}.
-
- @item dither
- Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
- (enabled).
-
- @item aspect
- Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
- Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
- following the dimensions of the video.
-
- Default is @code{1/1}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Expressions
-
- The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
- following parameters.
-
- @table @option
- @item w
- @item h
- input width and height
-
- @item n
- the number of input frame, starting from 0
-
- @item pts
- the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
- @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
-
- @item r
- frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
-
- @item t
- the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
- expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
-
- @item tb
- time base of the input video
- @end table
-
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
- @example
- vignette=PI/4
- @end example
-
- @item
- Make a flickering vignetting:
- @example
- vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section vstack
- Stack input videos vertically.
-
- All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
-
- Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
- to create same output.
-
- The filter accept the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item inputs
- Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
-
- @item shortest
- If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
- terminates. Default value is 0.
- @end table
-
- @section w3fdif
-
- Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
- Deinterlacing Filter").
-
- Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
- implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
- Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
- uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
-
- There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple":
- and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
- be set by passing an optional parameter:
-
- @table @option
- @item filter
- Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item simple
- Simple filter coefficient set.
- @item complex
- More-complex filter coefficient set.
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{complex}.
-
- @item deint
- Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following values:
-
- @table @samp
- @item all
- Deinterlace all frames,
- @item interlaced
- Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{all}.
- @end table
-
- @section waveform
- Video waveform monitor.
-
- The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
- only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
- source video.
-
- It accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode, m
- Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
- In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
- the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
- color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
-
- @item intensity, i
- Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
- luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
- Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
-
- @item mirror, r
- Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
- In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
- side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
- @code{1} (mirrored).
-
- @item display, d
- Set display mode.
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item overlay
- Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
- that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
- over one another.
-
- This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
- in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
- such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
-
- @item stack
- Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
- @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
-
- @item parade
- Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
- @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
-
- Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
- and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
- graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
- by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
- should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
- correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
- @end table
- Default is @code{stack}.
-
- @item components, c
- Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
- or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
- 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
-
- @item envelope, e
- @table @samp
- @item none
- No envelope, this is default.
-
- @item instant
- Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
- visible even with small @code{step} value.
-
- @item peak
- Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
- can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
-
- @item peak+instant
- Peak and instant envelope combined together.
- @end table
-
- @item filter, f
- @table @samp
- @item lowpass
- No filtering, this is default.
-
- @item flat
- Luma and chroma combined together.
-
- @item aflat
- Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
-
- @item chroma
- Displays only chroma.
-
- @item color
- Displays actual color value on waveform.
-
- @item acolor
- Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
- @end table
-
- @item graticule, g
- Set which graticule to display.
-
- @table @samp
- @item none
- Do not display graticule.
-
- @item green
- Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
- @end table
-
- @item opacity, o
- Set graticule opacity.
-
- @item flags, fl
- Set graticule flags.
-
- @table @samp
- @item numbers
- Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
-
- @item dots
- Draw dots instead of lines.
- @end table
-
- @item scale, s
- Set scale used for displaying graticule.
-
- @table @samp
- @item digital
- @item millivolts
- @item ire
- @end table
- Default is digital.
- @end table
-
- @section xbr
- Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
- art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
- @url{http://www.libretro.com/forums/viewtopic.php?f=6&t=134}.
-
- It accepts the following option:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
- @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
- Default is @code{3}.
- @end table
-
- @anchor{yadif}
- @section yadif
-
- Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
- filter").
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
-
- @table @option
-
- @item mode
- The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, send_frame
- Output one frame for each frame.
- @item 1, send_field
- Output one frame for each field.
- @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
- Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
- @item 3, send_field_nospatial
- Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{send_frame}.
-
- @item parity
- The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
- of the following values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, tff
- Assume the top field is first.
- @item 1, bff
- Assume the bottom field is first.
- @item -1, auto
- Enable automatic detection of field parity.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{auto}.
- If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
- top field first will be assumed.
-
- @item deint
- Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accept one of the following
- values:
-
- @table @option
- @item 0, all
- Deinterlace all frames.
- @item 1, interlaced
- Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
- @end table
-
- The default value is @code{all}.
- @end table
-
- @section zoompan
-
- Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item zoom, z
- Set the zoom expression. Default is 1.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
-
- @item d
- Set the duration expression in number of frames.
- This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
- single input image.
-
- @item s
- Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
-
- @item fps
- Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
- @end table
-
- Each expression can contain the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item in_w, iw
- Input width.
-
- @item in_h, ih
- Input height.
-
- @item out_w, ow
- Output width.
-
- @item out_h, oh
- Output height.
-
- @item in
- Input frame count.
-
- @item on
- Output frame count.
-
- @item x
- @item y
- Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
- for current input frame.
-
- @item px
- @item py
- 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
- not yet such frame (first input frame).
-
- @item zoom
- Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
-
- @item pzoom
- Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
-
- @item duration
- Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
- for each input frame.
-
- @item pduration
- number of output frames created for previous input frame
-
- @item a
- Rational number: input width / input height
-
- @item sar
- sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- display aspect ratio
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
- @example
- zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
- @end example
-
- @item
- Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
- @example
- zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section zscale
- Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
- https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg.
-
- The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
- as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
-
- If the input image format is different from the format requested by
- the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
- requested format.
-
- @subsection Options
- The filter accepts the following options.
-
- @table @option
- @item width, w
- @item height, h
- Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
- dimension.
-
- If the @var{width} or @var{w} is 0, the input width is used for the output.
- If the @var{height} or @var{h} is 0, the input height is used for the output.
-
- If one of the values is -1, the zscale filter will use a value that
- maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the
- other specified dimension. If both of them are -1, the input size is
- used
-
- If one of the values is -n with n > 1, the zscale filter will also use a value
- that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image, calculated from the other
- specified dimension. After that it will, however, make sure that the calculated
- dimension is divisible by n and adjust the value if necessary.
-
- See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
- expression.
-
- @item size, s
- Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item dither, d
- Set the dither type.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item none
- @item ordered
- @item random
- @item error_diffusion
- @end table
-
- Default is none.
-
- @item filter, f
- Set the resize filter type.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item point
- @item bilinear
- @item bicubic
- @item spline16
- @item spline36
- @item lanczos
- @end table
-
- Default is bilinear.
-
- @item range, r
- Set the color range.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item limited
- @item full
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item primaries, p
- Set the color primaries.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 170m
- @item 240m
- @item 2020
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item transfer, t
- Set the transfer characteristics.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 601
- @item linear
- @item 2020_10
- @item 2020_12
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item matrix, m
- Set the colorspace matrix.
-
- Possible value are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 470bg
- @item 170m
- @item 2020_ncl
- @item 2020_cl
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item rangein, rin
- Set the input color range.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item limited
- @item full
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item primariesin, pin
- Set the input color primaries.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 170m
- @item 240m
- @item 2020
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item transferin, tin
- Set the input transfer characteristics.
-
- Possible values are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 601
- @item linear
- @item 2020_10
- @item 2020_12
- @end table
-
- Default is same as input.
-
- @item matrixin, min
- Set the input colorspace matrix.
-
- Possible value are:
- @table @var
- @item input
- @item 709
- @item unspecified
- @item 470bg
- @item 170m
- @item 2020_ncl
- @item 2020_cl
- @end table
- @end table
-
- The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
- containing the following constants:
-
- @table @var
- @item in_w
- @item in_h
- The input width and height
-
- @item iw
- @item ih
- These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
-
- @item out_w
- @item out_h
- The output (scaled) width and height
-
- @item ow
- @item oh
- These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
-
- @item a
- The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
-
- @item sar
- input sample aspect ratio
-
- @item dar
- The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
-
- @item hsub
- @item vsub
- horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
-
- @item ohsub
- @item ovsub
- horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
- pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
- @end table
-
- @table @option
- @end table
-
- @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
-
- @chapter Video Sources
- @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
-
- Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
-
- @section buffer
-
- Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
-
- This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
- through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item video_size
- Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
- syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item width
- The input video width.
-
- @item height
- The input video height.
-
- @item pix_fmt
- A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
- It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
- name.
-
- @item time_base
- Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
-
- @item frame_rate
- Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
-
- @item pixel_aspect, sar
- The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
-
- @item sws_param
- Specify the optional parameters to be used for the scale filter which
- is automatically inserted when an input change is detected in the
- input size or format.
-
- @item hw_frames_ctx
- When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
- AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
- @end table
-
- For example:
- @example
- buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
- @end example
-
- will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
- with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
- square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
- Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
- (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
- this example corresponds to:
- @example
- buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
- @end example
-
- Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
- syntax is deprecated:
-
- @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}[:@var{sws_param}]
-
- @section cellauto
-
- Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
-
- The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
- @option{filename}, and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
- not specified an initial state is created randomly.
-
- At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
- the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
- frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item filename, f
- Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
- the specified file.
- In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
- cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
- file will be ignored.
-
- @item pattern, p
- Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
- the specified string.
-
- Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
- cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
- string will be ignored.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
- Default is 25.
-
- @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
- Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
- is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
- 1/PHI.
-
- This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
-
- @item random_seed, seed
- Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
- included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
- set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
- effort basis.
-
- @item rule
- Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
- Default value is 110.
-
- @item size, s
- Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
- by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
- height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
-
- If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
- pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
- larger row.
-
- If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
- defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
-
- @item scroll
- If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
- have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
- written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
- Defaults to 1.
-
- @item start_full, full
- If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
- outputting the first frame.
- This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
-
- @item stitch
- If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
- This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
- size 200x400.
- @example
- cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
- ratio of 2/3:
- @example
- cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
- centered on an initial row with width 100:
- @example
- cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
- @end example
-
- @item
- Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
- @example
- cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{coreimagesrc}
- @section coreimagesrc
- Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
-
- This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
- Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
- generate the content.
-
- The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
- @table @option
- @item list_generators
- List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
- possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
- @example
- list_generators=true
- @end example
-
- @item size, s
- Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- The default value is @code{320x240}.
-
- @item rate, r
- Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
- generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
- @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
- number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
- "25".
-
- @item sar
- Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
-
- @item duration, d
- Set the duration of the sourced video. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
-
- If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
- supposed to be generated forever.
- @end table
-
- Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
- A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
- generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
- and examples for details.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
-
- @item
- Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
- given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
- @example
- ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
- @end example
- This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
- need for a nullsrc video source.
- @end itemize
-
-
- @section mandelbrot
-
- Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
- point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item end_pts
- Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
-
- @item end_scale
- Set the terminal scale value.
- Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
-
- @item inner
- Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
- Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
-
- It shall assume one of the following values:
- @table @option
- @item black
- Set black mode.
- @item convergence
- Show time until convergence.
- @item mincol
- Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
- @item period
- Set period mode.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @var{mincol}.
-
- @item bailout
- Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
-
- @item maxiter
- Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
- algorithm. Default value is 7189.
-
- @item outer
- Set outer coloring mode.
- It shall assume one of following values:
- @table @option
- @item iteration_count
- Set iteration cound mode.
- @item normalized_iteration_count
- set normalized iteration count mode.
- @end table
- Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
- value is "25".
-
- @item size, s
- Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the "Video
- size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual. Default value is "640x480".
-
- @item start_scale
- Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
-
- @item start_x
- Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
- -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
-
- @item start_y
- Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
- -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
- @end table
-
- @section mptestsrc
-
- Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
-
- The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
- This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item rate, r
- Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
- generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
- @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
- number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
- "25".
-
- @item duration, d
- Set the duration of the sourced video. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
-
- If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
- supposed to be generated forever.
-
- @item test, t
-
- Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
- @table @option
- @item dc_luma
- @item dc_chroma
- @item freq_luma
- @item freq_chroma
- @item amp_luma
- @item amp_chroma
- @item cbp
- @item mv
- @item ring1
- @item ring2
- @item all
-
- @end table
-
- Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
- @end table
-
- Some examples:
- @example
- mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
- @end example
-
- will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
-
- @section frei0r_src
-
- Provide a frei0r source.
-
- To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
- header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
-
- This source accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item size
- The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- @item framerate
- The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
- @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
-
- @item filter_name
- The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
- how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
- documentation.
-
- @item filter_params
- A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
-
- @end table
-
- For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
- and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
- @example
- frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
- @end example
-
- @section life
-
- Generate a life pattern.
-
- This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
-
- The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
- which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
- interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
- horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
-
- At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
- which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
- cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
- the rule to adopt.
-
- This source accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item filename, f
- Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
- each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
- is used to delimit the end of each row.
-
- If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
- randomly.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
- Default is 25.
-
- @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
- Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
- floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
- It is ignored when a file is specified.
-
- @item random_seed, seed
- Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
- included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
- set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
- effort basis.
-
- @item rule
- Set the life rule.
-
- A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
- where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
- @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
- live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
- which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
- "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
-
- Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
- high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
- for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
- the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
- higher number of neighbor cells.
- For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
- rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
-
- Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
- rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
- cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
- a dead cell.
-
- @item size, s
- Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
-
- If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
- same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
- the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
- that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
-
- If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
- (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
-
- @item stitch
- If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
- top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
-
- @item mold
- Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
- @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
- value from 0 to 255.
-
- @item life_color
- Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
-
- @item death_color
- Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
- used to represent a dead cell.
-
- @item mold_color
- Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
-
- For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the "Color" section in the
- ffmpeg-utils manual.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
- 300x300 pixels:
- @example
- life=f=pattern:s=300x300
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
- @example
- life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
- @end example
-
- @item
- Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
- @example
- life=rule=S14/B34
- @end example
-
- @item
- Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{allrgb}
- @anchor{allyuv}
- @anchor{color}
- @anchor{haldclutsrc}
- @anchor{nullsrc}
- @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
- @anchor{smptebars}
- @anchor{smptehdbars}
- @anchor{testsrc}
- @anchor{testsrc2}
- @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2
-
- The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
-
- The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
-
- The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
-
- The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
- @ref{haldclut} filter.
-
- The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
- mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
- source for filters which ignore the input data.
-
- The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
- detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
- stripe from top to bottom.
-
- The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
- the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
-
- The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
- the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
-
- The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
- color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
- intended for testing purposes.
-
- The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
- pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
- input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
-
- The sources accept the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item color, c
- Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
- source. For the syntax of this option, check the "Color" section in the
- ffmpeg-utils manual.
-
- @item level
- Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
- source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
- pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
- coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
-
- @item size, s
- Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- The default value is @code{320x240}.
-
- This option is not available with the @code{haldclutsrc} filter.
-
- @item rate, r
- Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
- generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
- @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
- number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
- "25".
-
- @item sar
- Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
-
- @item duration, d
- Set the duration of the sourced video. See
- @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
- for the accepted syntax.
-
- If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
- supposed to be generated forever.
-
- @item decimals, n
- Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
- @code{testsrc} source.
-
- The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
- timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
- value. Default value is 0.
- @end table
-
- For example the following:
- @example
- testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
- @end example
-
- will generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
- 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second.
-
- The following graph description will generate a red source
- with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
- frames per second.
- @example
- color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
- @end example
-
- If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
- following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
- the @code{geq} filter:
- @example
- nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
- @end example
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
-
- @table @option
- @item c, color
- Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
- corresponding @option{color} option.
- @end table
-
- @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
-
- @chapter Video Sinks
- @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
-
- Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
-
- @section buffersink
-
- Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
- graph.
-
- This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
- through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
- or the options system.
-
- It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
- defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
- parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
-
- @section nullsink
-
- Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
- mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
- tools.
-
- @c man end VIDEO SINKS
-
- @chapter Multimedia Filters
- @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
-
- Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
-
- @section ahistogram
-
- Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item dmode
- Specify how histogram is calculated.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item single
- Use single histogram for all channels.
- @item separate
- Use separate histogram for each channel.
- @end table
- Default is @code{single}.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
- value is "25".
-
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{hd720}.
-
- @item scale
- Set display scale.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item log
- logarithmic
- @item sqrt
- square root
- @item cbrt
- cubic root
- @item lin
- linear
- @item rlog
- reverse logarithmic
- @end table
- Default is @code{log}.
-
- @item ascale
- Set amplitude scale.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item log
- logarithmic
- @item lin
- linear
- @end table
- Default is @code{log}.
-
- @item acount
- Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
- Defauls is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
-
- @item rheight
- Set histogram ratio of window height.
-
- @item slide
- Set sonogram sliding.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item replace
- replace old rows with new ones.
- @item scroll
- scroll from top to bottom.
- @end table
- Default is @code{replace}.
- @end table
-
- @section aphasemeter
-
- Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio phase.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item rate, r
- Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
-
- @item size, s
- Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{800x400}.
-
- @item rc
- @item gc
- @item bc
- Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
- @code{7} and @code{1}.
- Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
-
- @item mpc
- Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
- @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
- @end table
-
- The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase} which
- represents mean phase of current audio frame. Value is in range @code{[-1, 1]}.
- The @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase and
- @code{1} means channels are in phase.
-
- @section avectorscope
-
- Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
- scope.
-
- The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
- audio stream. A monoaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
- signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
- as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
- If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
- indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode, m
- Set the vectorscope mode.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item lissajous
- Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
-
- @item lissajous_xy
- Same as above but not rotated.
-
- @item polar
- Shape resembling half of circle.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
-
- @item size, s
- Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{400x400}.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
-
- @item rc
- @item gc
- @item bc
- @item ac
- Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
- @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
- Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
-
- @item rf
- @item gf
- @item bf
- @item af
- Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
- @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
- Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
-
- @item zoom
- Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[1, 10]}.
-
- @item draw
- Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item dot
- Draw dot for each sample.
-
- @item line
- Draw line between previous and current sample.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{dot}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
- [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section bench, abench
-
- Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item action
- Start or stop a timer.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item start
- Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
- @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
-
- @item stop
- Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
- the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
- maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
- @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
- @end table
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
- @example
- bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section concat
-
- Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
- other.
-
- The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
- segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
- also be the number of streams at output.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item n
- Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
-
- @item v
- Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
- streams in each segment. Default is 1.
-
- @item a
- Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
- streams in each segment. Default is 0.
-
- @item unsafe
- Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
-
- @end table
-
- The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
- @var{a} audio outputs.
-
- There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
- segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
- segment, etc.
-
- Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
- reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
- related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
- concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
- stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
- audio streams with silence.
-
- For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
-
- All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
- filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
- streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
- audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
- explicitly by the user.
-
- Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
- at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
- (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
- @example
- ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
- '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
- concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
- -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
- @end example
-
- @item
- Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
- (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
- @example
- movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
- movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
- [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
- @end example
- Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
- do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
-
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{ebur128}
- @section ebur128
-
- EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as input and outputs
- it unchanged. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
- Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
- Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
-
- The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
- time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
- message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
- unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
- short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
- the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds).
-
- More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
- @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item video
- Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
- option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
- activated. Default is @code{0}.
-
- @item size
- Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
- option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
-
- @item meter
- Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
- @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
- other integer value between this range is allowed.
-
- @item metadata
- Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
- into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
- in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
-
- Default is @code{0}.
-
- @item framelog
- Force the frame logging level.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item info
- information logging level
- @item verbose
- verbose logging level
- @end table
-
- By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
- the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
-
- @item peak
- Set peak mode(s).
-
- Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
- values are:
- @table @samp
- @item none
- Disable any peak mode (default).
- @item sample
- Enable sample-peak mode.
-
- Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
- for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
- @item true
- Enable true-peak mode.
-
- If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
- stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
- (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
- This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
- @end table
-
- @item dualmono
- Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
- on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
- If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
- Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
-
- @item panlaw
- Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
- This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
- @end example
-
- @item
- Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section interleave, ainterleave
-
- Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
-
- @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
-
- These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
- queued frame to the output.
-
- Input streams must have a well defined, monotonically increasing frame
- timestamp values.
-
- In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
- at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
- input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
-
- For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
- which always drop input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
- reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
- to output until the input will send an end-of-stream signal.
-
- Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
- frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
- the queue is already filled.
-
- These filters accept the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item nb_inputs, n
- Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
- @end example
-
- @item
- Add flickering blur effect:
- @example
- select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section perms, aperms
-
- Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
-
- These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
- following filter in the filtergraph.
-
- The filters accept the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item mode
- Select the permissions mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item none
- Do nothing. This is the default.
- @item ro
- Set all the output frames read-only.
- @item rw
- Set all the output frames directly writable.
- @item toggle
- Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
- @item random
- Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
- @end table
-
- @item seed
- Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
- @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
- @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
- basis.
- @end table
-
- Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
- following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
- following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
- perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
-
- @section realtime, arealtime
-
- Slow down filtering to match real time approximatively.
-
- These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
- match the output rate with the input timestamps.
- They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
-
- They accept the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item limit
- Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
- a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
- @end table
-
- @section select, aselect
-
- Select frames to pass in output.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item expr, e
- Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
-
- If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
-
- If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
- first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
- @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
-
- For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
- @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
-
- @item outputs, n
- Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
- frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
- @end table
-
- The expression can contain the following constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item n
- The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item selected_n
- The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
-
- @item prev_selected_n
- The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item TB
- The timebase of the input timestamps.
-
- @item pts
- The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
- expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item t
- The PTS of the filtered video frame,
- expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item prev_pts
- The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item prev_selected_pts
- The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item prev_selected_t
- The PTS of the last previously selected video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item start_pts
- The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item start_t
- The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
-
- @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
- The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
- values:
- @table @option
- @item I
- @item P
- @item B
- @item S
- @item SI
- @item SP
- @item BI
- @end table
-
- @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
- The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
- @table @option
- @item PROGRESSIVE
- The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
- @item TOPFIRST
- The frame is top-field-first.
- @item BOTTOMFIRST
- The frame is bottom-field-first.
- @end table
-
- @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
- the number of selected samples before the current frame
-
- @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
- the number of samples in the current frame
-
- @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
- the input sample rate
-
- @item key
- This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
-
- @item pos
- the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
- is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
-
- @item scene @emph{(video only)}
- value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
- probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
- value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
-
- @item concatdec_select
- The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
- inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
- in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
- generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
- interval.
-
- This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
- and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
- present in the decoded frames.
-
- The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
- start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
- than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
- missing.
-
- That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
- interval set by the concat demuxer.
-
- @end table
-
- The default value of the select expression is "1".
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Select all frames in input:
- @example
- select
- @end example
-
- The example above is the same as:
- @example
- select=1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Skip all frames:
- @example
- select=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select only I-frames:
- @example
- select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select one frame every 100:
- @example
- select='not(mod(n\,100))'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
- @example
- select=between(t\,10\,20)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
- @example
- select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
- @example
- select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
- @example
- aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
- @end example
-
- Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
- choice.
-
- @item
- Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
- @example
- select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
- @end example
-
- @item
- Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
- outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
- @example
- ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section sendcmd, asendcmd
-
- Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
-
- These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
- filtergraph.
-
- @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
- @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
- from that they act the same way.
-
- The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
- with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
- @var{filename} option.
-
- These filters accept the following options:
- @table @option
- @item commands, c
- Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
- @item filename, f
- Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
- filters.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Commands syntax
-
- A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
- specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
- particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
- is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
- interval.
-
- An interval is specified by the following syntax:
- @example
- @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
- @end example
-
- The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
- @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
-
- The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
- it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
- the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
- @var{END}.
-
- @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
- specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
- syntax of a command specification is given by:
- @example
- [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
- @end example
-
- @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
- the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
- be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
- enclosed between "[" and "]".
-
- The following flags are recognized:
- @table @option
- @item enter
- The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
- specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
- previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
- current is.
-
- @item leave
- The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
- specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
- previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
- current is not.
- @end table
-
- If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
- assumed.
-
- @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
- the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
-
- @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
-
- @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
- the given @var{COMMAND}.
-
- Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
- sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
- are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
-
- A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
- follows:
- @example
- @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
- @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
- @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
- @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
- @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
- @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
- @end example
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
- @example
- asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
- @end example
-
- @item
- Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
- @example
- # show text in the interval 5-10
- 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
- [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
-
- # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
- 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
- [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
- [leave] hue s 1,
- [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
-
- # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
- 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
- @end example
-
- A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
- stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
- @example
- sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @anchor{setpts}
- @section setpts, asetpts
-
- Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
-
- @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
-
- This filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item expr
- The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
-
- @end table
-
- The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
- constants:
-
- @table @option
- @item FRAME_RATE
- frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
-
- @item PTS
- The presentation timestamp in input
-
- @item N
- The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
- not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
-
- @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
- The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
- audio)
-
- @item NB_SAMPLES, S
- The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
-
- @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
- The audio sample rate.
-
- @item STARTPTS
- The PTS of the first frame.
-
- @item STARTT
- the time in seconds of the first frame
-
- @item INTERLACED
- State whether the current frame is interlaced.
-
- @item T
- the time in seconds of the current frame
-
- @item POS
- original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
- for the current frame
-
- @item PREV_INPTS
- The previous input PTS.
-
- @item PREV_INT
- previous input time in seconds
-
- @item PREV_OUTPTS
- The previous output PTS.
-
- @item PREV_OUTT
- previous output time in seconds
-
- @item RTCTIME
- The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
- instead.
-
- @item RTCSTART
- The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
-
- @item TB
- The timebase of the input timestamps.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Start counting PTS from zero
- @example
- setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply fast motion effect:
- @example
- setpts=0.5*PTS
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply slow motion effect:
- @example
- setpts=2.0*PTS
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
- @example
- setpts=N/(25*TB)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
- @example
- setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
- @example
- setpts=PTS+10/TB
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
- @example
- setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Generate timestamps by counting samples:
- @example
- asetpts=N/SR/TB
- @end example
-
- @end itemize
-
- @section settb, asettb
-
- Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
- It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
-
- @item expr, tb
- The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
-
- @end table
-
- The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
- rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
- timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
- audio only). Default value is "intb".
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Set the timebase to 1/25:
- @example
- settb=expr=1/25
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the timebase to 1/10:
- @example
- settb=expr=0.1
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
- @example
- settb=1+0.001
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the timebase to 2*intb:
- @example
- settb=2*intb
- @end example
-
- @item
- Set the default timebase value:
- @example
- settb=AVTB
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section showcqt
- Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
- logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
- direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
- is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
- with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
- check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
-
- @item fps, rate, r
- Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
-
- @item bar_h
- Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
- computes the bargraph height automatically.
-
- @item axis_h
- Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
- the axis height automatically.
-
- @item sono_h
- Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
- computes the sonogram height automatically.
-
- @item fullhd
- Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
- instead. Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item sono_v, volume
- Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
- @table @option
- @item bar_v
- the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
- @item frequency, freq, f
- the frequency where it is evaluated
- @item timeclamp, tc
- the value of @var{timeclamp} option
- @end table
- and functions:
- @table @option
- @item a_weighting(f)
- A-weighting of equal loudness
- @item b_weighting(f)
- B-weighting of equal loudness
- @item c_weighting(f)
- C-weighting of equal loudness.
- @end table
- Default value is @code{16}.
-
- @item bar_v, volume2
- Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
- @table @option
- @item sono_v
- the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
- @item frequency, freq, f
- the frequency where it is evaluated
- @item timeclamp, tc
- the value of @var{timeclamp} option
- @end table
- and functions:
- @table @option
- @item a_weighting(f)
- A-weighting of equal loudness
- @item b_weighting(f)
- B-weighting of equal loudness
- @item c_weighting(f)
- C-weighting of equal loudness.
- @end table
- Default value is @code{sono_v}.
-
- @item sono_g, gamma
- Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
- higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
- Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
-
- @item bar_g, gamma2
- Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
- @code{[1, 7]}.
-
- @item timeclamp, tc
- Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
- accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
- event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
- otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
- (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.1, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
-
- @item basefreq
- Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
- which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
-
- @item endfreq
- Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
- which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
-
- @item coeffclamp
- This option is deprecated and ignored.
-
- @item tlength
- Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
- trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
- It can contain variables:
- @table @option
- @item frequency, freq, f
- the frequency where it is evaluated
- @item timeclamp, tc
- the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
- @end table
- Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
-
- @item count
- Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
- Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
-
- @item fcount
- Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
- which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
-
- @item fontfile
- Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
- use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
- implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
- option instead.
-
- @item fontcolor
- Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
- integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
- @table @option
- @item frequency, freq, f
- the frequency where it is evaluated
- @item timeclamp, tc
- the value of @var{timeclamp} option
- @end table
- and functions:
- @table @option
- @item midi(f)
- midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
- @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
- red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
- @end table
- Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
- st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
- r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
-
- @item axisfile
- Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
- @var{fontcolor} option.
-
- @item axis, text
- Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
- the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Playing at 1280x720:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Disable sonogram display:
- @example
- sono_h=0
- @end example
-
- @item
- A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
- asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
- asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Custom volume:
- @example
- bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
- @end example
-
- @item
- Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
- @example
- bar_g=2:sono_g=2
- @end example
-
- @item
- Custom tlength equation:
- @example
- tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
- @end example
-
- @item
- Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
- @example
- fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
- @end example
-
- @item
- Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
- @example
- axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section showfreqs
-
- Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
- Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default is @code{1024x512}.
-
- @item mode
- Set display mode.
- This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item line
- @item bar
- @item dot
- @end table
- Default is @code{bar}.
-
- @item ascale
- Set amplitude scale.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item lin
- Linear scale.
-
- @item sqrt
- Square root scale.
-
- @item cbrt
- Cubic root scale.
-
- @item log
- Logarithmic scale.
- @end table
- Default is @code{log}.
-
- @item fscale
- Set frequency scale.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item lin
- Linear scale.
-
- @item log
- Logarithmic scale.
-
- @item rlog
- Reverse logarithmic scale.
- @end table
- Default is @code{lin}.
-
- @item win_size
- Set window size.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item w16
- @item w32
- @item w64
- @item w128
- @item w256
- @item w512
- @item w1024
- @item w2048
- @item w4096
- @item w8192
- @item w16384
- @item w32768
- @item w65536
- @end table
- Default is @code{w2048}
-
- @item win_func
- Set windowing function.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item rect
- @item bartlett
- @item hanning
- @item hamming
- @item blackman
- @item welch
- @item flattop
- @item bharris
- @item bnuttall
- @item bhann
- @item sine
- @item nuttall
- @item lanczos
- @item gauss
- @item tukey
- @end table
- Default is @code{hanning}.
-
- @item overlap
- Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
- which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
-
- @item averaging
- Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
- Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
-
- @item colors
- Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
- draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
- by white color.
-
- @item cmode
- Set channel display mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item combined
- @item separate
- @end table
- Default is @code{combined}.
-
- @end table
-
- @anchor{showspectrum}
- @section showspectrum
-
- Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
- spectrum.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{640x512}.
-
- @item slide
- Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item replace
- the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
- @item scroll
- the samples scroll from right to left
- @item rscroll
- the samples scroll from left to right
- @item fullframe
- frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
- @end table
-
- Default value is @code{replace}.
-
- @item mode
- Specify display mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item combined
- all channels are displayed in the same row
- @item separate
- all channels are displayed in separate rows
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{combined}.
-
- @item color
- Specify display color mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item channel
- each channel is displayed in a separate color
- @item intensity
- each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
- @item rainbow
- each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
- @item moreland
- each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
- @item nebulae
- each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
- @item fire
- each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
- @item fiery
- each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
- @item fruit
- each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
- @item cool
- each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{channel}.
-
- @item scale
- Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item lin
- linear
- @item sqrt
- square root, default
- @item cbrt
- cubic root
- @item 4thrt
- 4th root
- @item 5thrt
- 5th root
- @item log
- logarithmic
- @end table
-
- Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
-
- @item saturation
- Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
- alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
- Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item win_func
- Set window function.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item rect
- @item bartlett
- @item hann
- @item hanning
- @item hamming
- @item blackman
- @item welch
- @item flattop
- @item bharris
- @item bnuttall
- @item bhann
- @item sine
- @item nuttall
- @item lanczos
- @item gauss
- @item tukey
- @end table
-
- Default value is @code{hann}.
-
- @item orientation
- Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
- @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
-
- @item overlap
- Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
- When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
- window function currently used.
-
- @item gain
- Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item data
- Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
- @end table
-
- The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
- section.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
- @example
- showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
- @end example
-
- @item
- Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
- @example
- ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
- [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section showspectrumpic
-
- Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
- spectrum.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
-
- @item mode
- Specify display mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item combined
- all channels are displayed in the same row
- @item separate
- all channels are displayed in separate rows
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{combined}.
-
- @item color
- Specify display color mode.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item channel
- each channel is displayed in a separate color
- @item intensity
- each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
- @item rainbow
- each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
- @item moreland
- each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
- @item nebulae
- each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
- @item fire
- each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
- @item fiery
- each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
- @item fruit
- each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
- @item cool
- each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{intensity}.
-
- @item scale
- Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item lin
- linear
- @item sqrt
- square root, default
- @item cbrt
- cubic root
- @item 4thrt
- 4th root
- @item 5thrt
- 5th root
- @item log
- logarithmic
- @end table
- Default value is @samp{log}.
-
- @item saturation
- Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
- alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
- Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item win_func
- Set window function.
-
- It accepts the following values:
- @table @samp
- @item rect
- @item bartlett
- @item hann
- @item hanning
- @item hamming
- @item blackman
- @item welch
- @item flattop
- @item bharris
- @item bnuttall
- @item bhann
- @item sine
- @item nuttall
- @item lanczos
- @item gauss
- @item tukey
- @end table
- Default value is @code{hann}.
-
- @item orientation
- Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
- @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
-
- @item gain
- Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
- Default value is @code{1}.
-
- @item legend
- Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
- in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section showvolume
-
- Convert input audio volume to a video output.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item rate, r
- Set video rate.
-
- @item b
- Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
-
- @item w
- Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
-
- @item h
- Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
-
- @item f
- Set fade, allowed range is [0.001, 1]. Default is 0.95.
-
- @item c
- Set volume color expression.
-
- The expression can use the following variables:
-
- @table @option
- @item VOLUME
- Current max volume of channel in dB.
-
- @item CHANNEL
- Current channel number, starting from 0.
- @end table
-
- @item t
- If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
-
- @item v
- If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
-
- @item o
- Set orientation, can be @code{horizontal} or @code{vertical},
- default is @code{horizontal}.
-
- @item s
- Set step size, allowed range s [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
- step is disabled.
- @end table
-
- @section showwaves
-
- Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{600x240}.
-
- @item mode
- Set display mode.
-
- Available values are:
- @table @samp
- @item point
- Draw a point for each sample.
-
- @item line
- Draw a vertical line for each sample.
-
- @item p2p
- Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
-
- @item cline
- Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
- @end table
-
- Default value is @code{point}.
-
- @item n
- Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
- larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
- integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
- is not explicitly specified.
-
- @item rate, r
- Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
- option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
-
- @item split_channels
- Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
-
- @item colors
- Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
-
- @item scale
- Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
- Default is linear.
-
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
- at the same time:
- @example
- amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
- frame rate of 30 frames per second:
- @example
- aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section showwavespic
-
- Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item size, s
- Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
- @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
- Default value is @code{600x240}.
-
- @item split_channels
- Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
-
- @item colors
- Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
-
- @item scale
- Set amplitude scale. Can be linear @code{lin} or logarithmic @code{log}.
- Default is linear.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
- in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section spectrumsynth
-
- Sythesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
- magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
- The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
- to time domain as presented in audio output.
-
- This filter is primarly created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
- filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
- But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
- available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
- its just recreated from random noise.
- For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
- @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
- @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
- @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
- slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
-
- The filter accepts the following options:
-
- @table @option
- @item sample_rate
- Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
- spectrum was generated may differ.
-
- @item channels
- Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
-
- @item scale
- Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
- Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
-
- @item slide
- Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
- Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
- Default is @code{fullframe}.
-
- @item win_func
- Set window function used for resynthesis.
-
- @item overlap
- Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
- which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
-
- @item orientation
- Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
- Default is @code{vertical}.
- @end table
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
- then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
- ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
- ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section split, asplit
-
- Split input into several identical outputs.
-
- @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
-
- The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
- unspecified, it defaults to 2.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Create two separate outputs from the same input:
- @example
- [in] split [out0][out1]
- @end example
-
- @item
- To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
- outputs, like in:
- @example
- [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
- one padded:
- @example
- [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
- [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
- [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
- @end example
-
- @item
- Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
- @example
- ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @section zmq, azmq
-
- Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
- filters in the filtergraph.
-
- @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
- must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
- audio filters.
-
- To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
- headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
-
- For more information about libzmq see:
- @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
-
- The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
- receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
- @option{bind_address} option.
-
- The received message must be in the form:
- @example
- @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
- @end example
-
- @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
- the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
-
- @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
-
- @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
- given @var{COMMAND}.
-
- Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
- is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
- will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
- @example
- @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
- @var{MESSAGE}
- @end example
-
- @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
-
- @subsection Examples
-
- Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
- be used to send commands processed by these filters.
-
- Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}
- @example
- ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
- color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
- color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
- nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
- [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
- [bg+l][r] overlay=x=100 "
- @end example
-
- To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
- command can be used:
- @example
- echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
- @end example
-
- To change the right side:
- @example
- echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
- @end example
-
- @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
-
- @chapter Multimedia Sources
- @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
-
- Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
-
- @section amovie
-
- This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
- stream by default.
-
- @anchor{movie}
- @section movie
-
- Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
-
- It accepts the following parameters:
-
- @table @option
- @item filename
- The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
- device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
-
- @item format_name, f
- Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
- the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
- format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
-
- @item seek_point, sp
- Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
- starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
- @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
- postfix. The default value is "0".
-
- @item streams, s
- Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
- separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
- same order. The syntax is explained in the ``Stream specifiers''
- section in the ffmpeg manual. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
- respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
- is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
-
- @item stream_index, si
- Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
- the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
- value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
- audio instead of video.
-
- @item loop
- Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
- If the value is less than 1, the stream will be read again and again.
- Default value is "1".
-
- Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
- changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
- @end table
-
- It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
- a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
- @example
- input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
- ^
- |
- movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
- @end example
- @subsection Examples
-
- @itemize
- @item
- Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
- on top of the input labelled "in":
- @example
- movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
- [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
- [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
- @end example
-
- @item
- Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
- labelled "in":
- @example
- movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
- [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
- [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
- @end example
-
- @item
- Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
- dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
- connected to the pad named "audio":
- @example
- movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
- @end example
- @end itemize
-
- @subsection Commands
-
- Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
- @table @option
- @item seek
- Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
- The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
- @itemize
- @item
- @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
- stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
- from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
- @item
- @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
- or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
- @item
- @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
- @end itemize
-
- @item get_duration
- Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
-
- @end table
-
- @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
|